]>
Commit | Line | Data |
---|---|---|
f0706e82 | 1 | /* |
3017b80b JB |
2 | * mac80211 <-> driver interface |
3 | * | |
f0706e82 JB |
4 | * Copyright 2002-2005, Devicescape Software, Inc. |
5 | * Copyright 2006-2007 Jiri Benc <jbenc@suse.cz> | |
026331c4 | 6 | * Copyright 2007-2010 Johannes Berg <johannes@sipsolutions.net> |
f0706e82 JB |
7 | * |
8 | * This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify | |
9 | * it under the terms of the GNU General Public License version 2 as | |
10 | * published by the Free Software Foundation. | |
11 | */ | |
12 | ||
13 | #ifndef MAC80211_H | |
14 | #define MAC80211_H | |
15 | ||
187f1882 | 16 | #include <linux/bug.h> |
f0706e82 JB |
17 | #include <linux/kernel.h> |
18 | #include <linux/if_ether.h> | |
19 | #include <linux/skbuff.h> | |
f0706e82 | 20 | #include <linux/ieee80211.h> |
f0706e82 | 21 | #include <net/cfg80211.h> |
42d98795 | 22 | #include <asm/unaligned.h> |
f0706e82 | 23 | |
75a5f0cc JB |
24 | /** |
25 | * DOC: Introduction | |
26 | * | |
27 | * mac80211 is the Linux stack for 802.11 hardware that implements | |
28 | * only partial functionality in hard- or firmware. This document | |
29 | * defines the interface between mac80211 and low-level hardware | |
30 | * drivers. | |
31 | */ | |
32 | ||
33 | /** | |
34 | * DOC: Calling mac80211 from interrupts | |
35 | * | |
36 | * Only ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() can be | |
f0706e82 JB |
37 | * called in hardware interrupt context. The low-level driver must not call any |
38 | * other functions in hardware interrupt context. If there is a need for such | |
39 | * call, the low-level driver should first ACK the interrupt and perform the | |
2485f710 JB |
40 | * IEEE 802.11 code call after this, e.g. from a scheduled workqueue or even |
41 | * tasklet function. | |
42 | * | |
43 | * NOTE: If the driver opts to use the _irqsafe() functions, it may not also | |
6ef307bc | 44 | * use the non-IRQ-safe functions! |
f0706e82 JB |
45 | */ |
46 | ||
75a5f0cc JB |
47 | /** |
48 | * DOC: Warning | |
49 | * | |
50 | * If you're reading this document and not the header file itself, it will | |
51 | * be incomplete because not all documentation has been converted yet. | |
52 | */ | |
53 | ||
54 | /** | |
55 | * DOC: Frame format | |
56 | * | |
57 | * As a general rule, when frames are passed between mac80211 and the driver, | |
58 | * they start with the IEEE 802.11 header and include the same octets that are | |
59 | * sent over the air except for the FCS which should be calculated by the | |
60 | * hardware. | |
61 | * | |
62 | * There are, however, various exceptions to this rule for advanced features: | |
63 | * | |
64 | * The first exception is for hardware encryption and decryption offload | |
65 | * where the IV/ICV may or may not be generated in hardware. | |
66 | * | |
67 | * Secondly, when the hardware handles fragmentation, the frame handed to | |
68 | * the driver from mac80211 is the MSDU, not the MPDU. | |
f0706e82 JB |
69 | */ |
70 | ||
42935eca LR |
71 | /** |
72 | * DOC: mac80211 workqueue | |
73 | * | |
74 | * mac80211 provides its own workqueue for drivers and internal mac80211 use. | |
75 | * The workqueue is a single threaded workqueue and can only be accessed by | |
76 | * helpers for sanity checking. Drivers must ensure all work added onto the | |
77 | * mac80211 workqueue should be cancelled on the driver stop() callback. | |
78 | * | |
79 | * mac80211 will flushed the workqueue upon interface removal and during | |
80 | * suspend. | |
81 | * | |
82 | * All work performed on the mac80211 workqueue must not acquire the RTNL lock. | |
83 | * | |
84 | */ | |
85 | ||
313162d0 PG |
86 | struct device; |
87 | ||
e100bb64 JB |
88 | /** |
89 | * enum ieee80211_max_queues - maximum number of queues | |
90 | * | |
91 | * @IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUES: Maximum number of regular device queues. | |
445ea4e8 | 92 | * @IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUE_MAP: bitmap with maximum queues set |
e100bb64 JB |
93 | */ |
94 | enum ieee80211_max_queues { | |
3a25a8c8 | 95 | IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUES = 16, |
445ea4e8 | 96 | IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUE_MAP = BIT(IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUES) - 1, |
e100bb64 JB |
97 | }; |
98 | ||
3a25a8c8 JB |
99 | #define IEEE80211_INVAL_HW_QUEUE 0xff |
100 | ||
4bce22b9 JB |
101 | /** |
102 | * enum ieee80211_ac_numbers - AC numbers as used in mac80211 | |
103 | * @IEEE80211_AC_VO: voice | |
104 | * @IEEE80211_AC_VI: video | |
105 | * @IEEE80211_AC_BE: best effort | |
106 | * @IEEE80211_AC_BK: background | |
107 | */ | |
108 | enum ieee80211_ac_numbers { | |
109 | IEEE80211_AC_VO = 0, | |
110 | IEEE80211_AC_VI = 1, | |
111 | IEEE80211_AC_BE = 2, | |
112 | IEEE80211_AC_BK = 3, | |
113 | }; | |
948d887d | 114 | #define IEEE80211_NUM_ACS 4 |
4bce22b9 | 115 | |
6b301cdf JB |
116 | /** |
117 | * struct ieee80211_tx_queue_params - transmit queue configuration | |
118 | * | |
119 | * The information provided in this structure is required for QoS | |
3330d7be | 120 | * transmit queue configuration. Cf. IEEE 802.11 7.3.2.29. |
6b301cdf | 121 | * |
e37d4dff | 122 | * @aifs: arbitration interframe space [0..255] |
f434b2d1 JB |
123 | * @cw_min: minimum contention window [a value of the form |
124 | * 2^n-1 in the range 1..32767] | |
6b301cdf | 125 | * @cw_max: maximum contention window [like @cw_min] |
3330d7be | 126 | * @txop: maximum burst time in units of 32 usecs, 0 meaning disabled |
908f8d07 | 127 | * @acm: is mandatory admission control required for the access category |
9d173fc5 | 128 | * @uapsd: is U-APSD mode enabled for the queue |
6b301cdf | 129 | */ |
f0706e82 | 130 | struct ieee80211_tx_queue_params { |
f434b2d1 | 131 | u16 txop; |
3330d7be JB |
132 | u16 cw_min; |
133 | u16 cw_max; | |
f434b2d1 | 134 | u8 aifs; |
908f8d07 | 135 | bool acm; |
ab13315a | 136 | bool uapsd; |
f0706e82 JB |
137 | }; |
138 | ||
f0706e82 JB |
139 | struct ieee80211_low_level_stats { |
140 | unsigned int dot11ACKFailureCount; | |
141 | unsigned int dot11RTSFailureCount; | |
142 | unsigned int dot11FCSErrorCount; | |
143 | unsigned int dot11RTSSuccessCount; | |
144 | }; | |
145 | ||
d01a1e65 MK |
146 | /** |
147 | * enum ieee80211_chanctx_change - change flag for channel context | |
4bf88530 | 148 | * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_WIDTH: The channel width changed |
04ecd257 | 149 | * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_RX_CHAINS: The number of RX chains changed |
164eb02d | 150 | * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_RADAR: radar detection flag changed |
73da7d5b SW |
151 | * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_CHANNEL: switched to another operating channel, |
152 | * this is used only with channel switching with CSA | |
21f659bf | 153 | * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_MIN_WIDTH: The min required channel width changed |
d01a1e65 MK |
154 | */ |
155 | enum ieee80211_chanctx_change { | |
4bf88530 | 156 | IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_WIDTH = BIT(0), |
04ecd257 | 157 | IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_RX_CHAINS = BIT(1), |
164eb02d | 158 | IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_RADAR = BIT(2), |
73da7d5b | 159 | IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_CHANNEL = BIT(3), |
21f659bf | 160 | IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_MIN_WIDTH = BIT(4), |
d01a1e65 MK |
161 | }; |
162 | ||
163 | /** | |
164 | * struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf - channel context that vifs may be tuned to | |
165 | * | |
166 | * This is the driver-visible part. The ieee80211_chanctx | |
167 | * that contains it is visible in mac80211 only. | |
168 | * | |
4bf88530 | 169 | * @def: the channel definition |
21f659bf | 170 | * @min_def: the minimum channel definition currently required. |
04ecd257 JB |
171 | * @rx_chains_static: The number of RX chains that must always be |
172 | * active on the channel to receive MIMO transmissions | |
173 | * @rx_chains_dynamic: The number of RX chains that must be enabled | |
174 | * after RTS/CTS handshake to receive SMPS MIMO transmissions; | |
5d7fad48 | 175 | * this will always be >= @rx_chains_static. |
164eb02d | 176 | * @radar_enabled: whether radar detection is enabled on this channel. |
d01a1e65 MK |
177 | * @drv_priv: data area for driver use, will always be aligned to |
178 | * sizeof(void *), size is determined in hw information. | |
179 | */ | |
180 | struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf { | |
4bf88530 | 181 | struct cfg80211_chan_def def; |
21f659bf | 182 | struct cfg80211_chan_def min_def; |
d01a1e65 | 183 | |
04ecd257 JB |
184 | u8 rx_chains_static, rx_chains_dynamic; |
185 | ||
164eb02d SW |
186 | bool radar_enabled; |
187 | ||
1c06ef98 | 188 | u8 drv_priv[0] __aligned(sizeof(void *)); |
d01a1e65 MK |
189 | }; |
190 | ||
1a5f0c13 LC |
191 | /** |
192 | * enum ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode - channel context switch mode | |
193 | * @CHANCTX_SWMODE_REASSIGN_VIF: Both old and new contexts already | |
194 | * exist (and will continue to exist), but the virtual interface | |
195 | * needs to be switched from one to the other. | |
196 | * @CHANCTX_SWMODE_SWAP_CONTEXTS: The old context exists but will stop | |
197 | * to exist with this call, the new context doesn't exist but | |
198 | * will be active after this call, the virtual interface switches | |
199 | * from the old to the new (note that the driver may of course | |
200 | * implement this as an on-the-fly chandef switch of the existing | |
201 | * hardware context, but the mac80211 pointer for the old context | |
202 | * will cease to exist and only the new one will later be used | |
203 | * for changes/removal.) | |
204 | */ | |
205 | enum ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode { | |
206 | CHANCTX_SWMODE_REASSIGN_VIF, | |
207 | CHANCTX_SWMODE_SWAP_CONTEXTS, | |
208 | }; | |
209 | ||
210 | /** | |
211 | * struct ieee80211_vif_chanctx_switch - vif chanctx switch information | |
212 | * | |
213 | * This is structure is used to pass information about a vif that | |
214 | * needs to switch from one chanctx to another. The | |
215 | * &ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode defines how the switch should be | |
216 | * done. | |
217 | * | |
218 | * @vif: the vif that should be switched from old_ctx to new_ctx | |
219 | * @old_ctx: the old context to which the vif was assigned | |
220 | * @new_ctx: the new context to which the vif must be assigned | |
221 | */ | |
222 | struct ieee80211_vif_chanctx_switch { | |
223 | struct ieee80211_vif *vif; | |
224 | struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *old_ctx; | |
225 | struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *new_ctx; | |
226 | }; | |
227 | ||
471b3efd JB |
228 | /** |
229 | * enum ieee80211_bss_change - BSS change notification flags | |
230 | * | |
231 | * These flags are used with the bss_info_changed() callback | |
232 | * to indicate which BSS parameter changed. | |
233 | * | |
234 | * @BSS_CHANGED_ASSOC: association status changed (associated/disassociated), | |
235 | * also implies a change in the AID. | |
236 | * @BSS_CHANGED_ERP_CTS_PROT: CTS protection changed | |
237 | * @BSS_CHANGED_ERP_PREAMBLE: preamble changed | |
9f1ba906 | 238 | * @BSS_CHANGED_ERP_SLOT: slot timing changed |
38668c05 | 239 | * @BSS_CHANGED_HT: 802.11n parameters changed |
96dd22ac | 240 | * @BSS_CHANGED_BASIC_RATES: Basic rateset changed |
57c4d7b4 | 241 | * @BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INT: Beacon interval changed |
2d0ddec5 JB |
242 | * @BSS_CHANGED_BSSID: BSSID changed, for whatever |
243 | * reason (IBSS and managed mode) | |
244 | * @BSS_CHANGED_BEACON: Beacon data changed, retrieve | |
245 | * new beacon (beaconing modes) | |
246 | * @BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_ENABLED: Beaconing should be | |
247 | * enabled/disabled (beaconing modes) | |
a97c13c3 | 248 | * @BSS_CHANGED_CQM: Connection quality monitor config changed |
8fc214ba | 249 | * @BSS_CHANGED_IBSS: IBSS join status changed |
68542962 | 250 | * @BSS_CHANGED_ARP_FILTER: Hardware ARP filter address list or state changed. |
4ced3f74 JB |
251 | * @BSS_CHANGED_QOS: QoS for this association was enabled/disabled. Note |
252 | * that it is only ever disabled for station mode. | |
7da7cc1d | 253 | * @BSS_CHANGED_IDLE: Idle changed for this BSS/interface. |
0ca54f6c | 254 | * @BSS_CHANGED_SSID: SSID changed for this BSS (AP and IBSS mode) |
02945821 | 255 | * @BSS_CHANGED_AP_PROBE_RESP: Probe Response changed for this BSS (AP mode) |
ab095877 | 256 | * @BSS_CHANGED_PS: PS changed for this BSS (STA mode) |
1ea6f9c0 | 257 | * @BSS_CHANGED_TXPOWER: TX power setting changed for this interface |
488dd7b5 JB |
258 | * @BSS_CHANGED_P2P_PS: P2P powersave settings (CTWindow, opportunistic PS) |
259 | * changed (currently only in P2P client mode, GO mode will be later) | |
989c6505 AB |
260 | * @BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INFO: Data from the AP's beacon became available: |
261 | * currently dtim_period only is under consideration. | |
2c9b7359 JB |
262 | * @BSS_CHANGED_BANDWIDTH: The bandwidth used by this interface changed, |
263 | * note that this is only called when it changes after the channel | |
264 | * context had been assigned. | |
471b3efd JB |
265 | */ |
266 | enum ieee80211_bss_change { | |
267 | BSS_CHANGED_ASSOC = 1<<0, | |
268 | BSS_CHANGED_ERP_CTS_PROT = 1<<1, | |
269 | BSS_CHANGED_ERP_PREAMBLE = 1<<2, | |
9f1ba906 | 270 | BSS_CHANGED_ERP_SLOT = 1<<3, |
a7ce1c94 | 271 | BSS_CHANGED_HT = 1<<4, |
96dd22ac | 272 | BSS_CHANGED_BASIC_RATES = 1<<5, |
57c4d7b4 | 273 | BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INT = 1<<6, |
2d0ddec5 JB |
274 | BSS_CHANGED_BSSID = 1<<7, |
275 | BSS_CHANGED_BEACON = 1<<8, | |
276 | BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_ENABLED = 1<<9, | |
a97c13c3 | 277 | BSS_CHANGED_CQM = 1<<10, |
8fc214ba | 278 | BSS_CHANGED_IBSS = 1<<11, |
68542962 | 279 | BSS_CHANGED_ARP_FILTER = 1<<12, |
4ced3f74 | 280 | BSS_CHANGED_QOS = 1<<13, |
7da7cc1d | 281 | BSS_CHANGED_IDLE = 1<<14, |
7827493b | 282 | BSS_CHANGED_SSID = 1<<15, |
02945821 | 283 | BSS_CHANGED_AP_PROBE_RESP = 1<<16, |
ab095877 | 284 | BSS_CHANGED_PS = 1<<17, |
1ea6f9c0 | 285 | BSS_CHANGED_TXPOWER = 1<<18, |
488dd7b5 | 286 | BSS_CHANGED_P2P_PS = 1<<19, |
989c6505 | 287 | BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INFO = 1<<20, |
2c9b7359 | 288 | BSS_CHANGED_BANDWIDTH = 1<<21, |
ac8dd506 JB |
289 | |
290 | /* when adding here, make sure to change ieee80211_reconfig */ | |
471b3efd JB |
291 | }; |
292 | ||
68542962 JO |
293 | /* |
294 | * The maximum number of IPv4 addresses listed for ARP filtering. If the number | |
295 | * of addresses for an interface increase beyond this value, hardware ARP | |
296 | * filtering will be disabled. | |
297 | */ | |
298 | #define IEEE80211_BSS_ARP_ADDR_LIST_LEN 4 | |
299 | ||
615f7b9b MV |
300 | /** |
301 | * enum ieee80211_rssi_event - RSSI threshold event | |
302 | * An indicator for when RSSI goes below/above a certain threshold. | |
303 | * @RSSI_EVENT_HIGH: AP's rssi crossed the high threshold set by the driver. | |
304 | * @RSSI_EVENT_LOW: AP's rssi crossed the low threshold set by the driver. | |
305 | */ | |
306 | enum ieee80211_rssi_event { | |
307 | RSSI_EVENT_HIGH, | |
308 | RSSI_EVENT_LOW, | |
309 | }; | |
310 | ||
471b3efd JB |
311 | /** |
312 | * struct ieee80211_bss_conf - holds the BSS's changing parameters | |
313 | * | |
314 | * This structure keeps information about a BSS (and an association | |
315 | * to that BSS) that can change during the lifetime of the BSS. | |
316 | * | |
317 | * @assoc: association status | |
8fc214ba JB |
318 | * @ibss_joined: indicates whether this station is part of an IBSS |
319 | * or not | |
c13a765b | 320 | * @ibss_creator: indicates if a new IBSS network is being created |
471b3efd JB |
321 | * @aid: association ID number, valid only when @assoc is true |
322 | * @use_cts_prot: use CTS protection | |
7a5158ef JB |
323 | * @use_short_preamble: use 802.11b short preamble; |
324 | * if the hardware cannot handle this it must set the | |
325 | * IEEE80211_HW_2GHZ_SHORT_PREAMBLE_INCAPABLE hardware flag | |
326 | * @use_short_slot: use short slot time (only relevant for ERP); | |
327 | * if the hardware cannot handle this it must set the | |
328 | * IEEE80211_HW_2GHZ_SHORT_SLOT_INCAPABLE hardware flag | |
56007a02 | 329 | * @dtim_period: num of beacons before the next DTIM, for beaconing, |
c65dd147 | 330 | * valid in station mode only if after the driver was notified |
989c6505 | 331 | * with the %BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INFO flag, will be non-zero then. |
8c358bcd | 332 | * @sync_tsf: last beacon's/probe response's TSF timestamp (could be old |
ef429dad JB |
333 | * as it may have been received during scanning long ago). If the |
334 | * HW flag %IEEE80211_HW_TIMING_BEACON_ONLY is set, then this can | |
335 | * only come from a beacon, but might not become valid until after | |
336 | * association when a beacon is received (which is notified with the | |
337 | * %BSS_CHANGED_DTIM flag.) | |
8c358bcd JB |
338 | * @sync_device_ts: the device timestamp corresponding to the sync_tsf, |
339 | * the driver/device can use this to calculate synchronisation | |
ef429dad JB |
340 | * (see @sync_tsf) |
341 | * @sync_dtim_count: Only valid when %IEEE80211_HW_TIMING_BEACON_ONLY | |
342 | * is requested, see @sync_tsf/@sync_device_ts. | |
21c0cbe7 | 343 | * @beacon_int: beacon interval |
98f7dfd8 | 344 | * @assoc_capability: capabilities taken from assoc resp |
96dd22ac JB |
345 | * @basic_rates: bitmap of basic rates, each bit stands for an |
346 | * index into the rate table configured by the driver in | |
347 | * the current band. | |
817cee76 | 348 | * @beacon_rate: associated AP's beacon TX rate |
dd5b4cc7 | 349 | * @mcast_rate: per-band multicast rate index + 1 (0: disabled) |
2d0ddec5 JB |
350 | * @bssid: The BSSID for this BSS |
351 | * @enable_beacon: whether beaconing should be enabled or not | |
4bf88530 JB |
352 | * @chandef: Channel definition for this BSS -- the hardware might be |
353 | * configured a higher bandwidth than this BSS uses, for example. | |
074d46d1 | 354 | * @ht_operation_mode: HT operation mode like in &struct ieee80211_ht_operation. |
9ed6bcce | 355 | * This field is only valid when the channel type is one of the HT types. |
a97c13c3 JO |
356 | * @cqm_rssi_thold: Connection quality monitor RSSI threshold, a zero value |
357 | * implies disabled | |
358 | * @cqm_rssi_hyst: Connection quality monitor RSSI hysteresis | |
68542962 JO |
359 | * @arp_addr_list: List of IPv4 addresses for hardware ARP filtering. The |
360 | * may filter ARP queries targeted for other addresses than listed here. | |
361 | * The driver must allow ARP queries targeted for all address listed here | |
362 | * to pass through. An empty list implies no ARP queries need to pass. | |
0f19b41e JB |
363 | * @arp_addr_cnt: Number of addresses currently on the list. Note that this |
364 | * may be larger than %IEEE80211_BSS_ARP_ADDR_LIST_LEN (the arp_addr_list | |
365 | * array size), it's up to the driver what to do in that case. | |
4ced3f74 | 366 | * @qos: This is a QoS-enabled BSS. |
7da7cc1d JB |
367 | * @idle: This interface is idle. There's also a global idle flag in the |
368 | * hardware config which may be more appropriate depending on what | |
369 | * your driver/device needs to do. | |
ab095877 EP |
370 | * @ps: power-save mode (STA only). This flag is NOT affected by |
371 | * offchannel/dynamic_ps operations. | |
0ca54f6c | 372 | * @ssid: The SSID of the current vif. Valid in AP and IBSS mode. |
7827493b AN |
373 | * @ssid_len: Length of SSID given in @ssid. |
374 | * @hidden_ssid: The SSID of the current vif is hidden. Only valid in AP-mode. | |
1ea6f9c0 | 375 | * @txpower: TX power in dBm |
67baf663 | 376 | * @p2p_noa_attr: P2P NoA attribute for P2P powersave |
471b3efd JB |
377 | */ |
378 | struct ieee80211_bss_conf { | |
2d0ddec5 | 379 | const u8 *bssid; |
471b3efd | 380 | /* association related data */ |
8fc214ba | 381 | bool assoc, ibss_joined; |
c13a765b | 382 | bool ibss_creator; |
471b3efd JB |
383 | u16 aid; |
384 | /* erp related data */ | |
385 | bool use_cts_prot; | |
386 | bool use_short_preamble; | |
9f1ba906 | 387 | bool use_short_slot; |
2d0ddec5 | 388 | bool enable_beacon; |
98f7dfd8 | 389 | u8 dtim_period; |
21c0cbe7 TW |
390 | u16 beacon_int; |
391 | u16 assoc_capability; | |
8c358bcd JB |
392 | u64 sync_tsf; |
393 | u32 sync_device_ts; | |
ef429dad | 394 | u8 sync_dtim_count; |
881d948c | 395 | u32 basic_rates; |
817cee76 | 396 | struct ieee80211_rate *beacon_rate; |
dd5b4cc7 | 397 | int mcast_rate[IEEE80211_NUM_BANDS]; |
9ed6bcce | 398 | u16 ht_operation_mode; |
a97c13c3 JO |
399 | s32 cqm_rssi_thold; |
400 | u32 cqm_rssi_hyst; | |
4bf88530 | 401 | struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef; |
68542962 | 402 | __be32 arp_addr_list[IEEE80211_BSS_ARP_ADDR_LIST_LEN]; |
0f19b41e | 403 | int arp_addr_cnt; |
4ced3f74 | 404 | bool qos; |
7da7cc1d | 405 | bool idle; |
ab095877 | 406 | bool ps; |
7827493b AN |
407 | u8 ssid[IEEE80211_MAX_SSID_LEN]; |
408 | size_t ssid_len; | |
409 | bool hidden_ssid; | |
1ea6f9c0 | 410 | int txpower; |
67baf663 | 411 | struct ieee80211_p2p_noa_attr p2p_noa_attr; |
471b3efd JB |
412 | }; |
413 | ||
11f4b1ce | 414 | /** |
af61a165 | 415 | * enum mac80211_tx_info_flags - flags to describe transmission information/status |
e039fa4a | 416 | * |
6ef307bc | 417 | * These flags are used with the @flags member of &ieee80211_tx_info. |
e039fa4a | 418 | * |
7351c6bd | 419 | * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_REQ_TX_STATUS: require TX status callback for this frame. |
e6a9854b JB |
420 | * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_ASSIGN_SEQ: The driver has to assign a sequence |
421 | * number to this frame, taking care of not overwriting the fragment | |
422 | * number and increasing the sequence number only when the | |
423 | * IEEE80211_TX_CTL_FIRST_FRAGMENT flag is set. mac80211 will properly | |
424 | * assign sequence numbers to QoS-data frames but cannot do so correctly | |
425 | * for non-QoS-data and management frames because beacons need them from | |
426 | * that counter as well and mac80211 cannot guarantee proper sequencing. | |
427 | * If this flag is set, the driver should instruct the hardware to | |
428 | * assign a sequence number to the frame or assign one itself. Cf. IEEE | |
429 | * 802.11-2007 7.1.3.4.1 paragraph 3. This flag will always be set for | |
430 | * beacons and always be clear for frames without a sequence number field. | |
e039fa4a | 431 | * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK: tell the low level not to wait for an ack |
e039fa4a JB |
432 | * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_CLEAR_PS_FILT: clear powersave filter for destination |
433 | * station | |
e039fa4a | 434 | * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_FIRST_FRAGMENT: this is a first fragment of the frame |
e039fa4a JB |
435 | * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_SEND_AFTER_DTIM: send this frame after DTIM beacon |
436 | * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_AMPDU: this frame should be sent as part of an A-MPDU | |
e6a9854b | 437 | * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_INJECTED: Frame was injected, internal to mac80211. |
e039fa4a | 438 | * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_TX_FILTERED: The frame was not transmitted |
ab5b5342 JB |
439 | * because the destination STA was in powersave mode. Note that to |
440 | * avoid race conditions, the filter must be set by the hardware or | |
441 | * firmware upon receiving a frame that indicates that the station | |
442 | * went to sleep (must be done on device to filter frames already on | |
443 | * the queue) and may only be unset after mac80211 gives the OK for | |
444 | * that by setting the IEEE80211_TX_CTL_CLEAR_PS_FILT (see above), | |
445 | * since only then is it guaranteed that no more frames are in the | |
446 | * hardware queue. | |
e039fa4a JB |
447 | * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_ACK: Frame was acknowledged |
448 | * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU: The frame was aggregated, so status | |
449 | * is for the whole aggregation. | |
429a3805 RR |
450 | * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU_NO_BACK: no block ack was returned, |
451 | * so consider using block ack request (BAR). | |
e6a9854b JB |
452 | * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_RATE_CTRL_PROBE: internal to mac80211, can be |
453 | * set by rate control algorithms to indicate probe rate, will | |
454 | * be cleared for fragmented frames (except on the last fragment) | |
6c17b77b SF |
455 | * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_OFFCHAN_TX_OK: Internal to mac80211. Used to indicate |
456 | * that a frame can be transmitted while the queues are stopped for | |
457 | * off-channel operation. | |
cd8ffc80 JB |
458 | * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_NEED_TXPROCESSING: completely internal to mac80211, |
459 | * used to indicate that a pending frame requires TX processing before | |
460 | * it can be sent out. | |
8f77f384 JB |
461 | * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_RETRIED: completely internal to mac80211, |
462 | * used to indicate that a frame was already retried due to PS | |
3b8d81e0 JB |
463 | * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_DONT_ENCRYPT: completely internal to mac80211, |
464 | * used to indicate frame should not be encrypted | |
02f2f1a9 JB |
465 | * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER: This frame is a response to a poll |
466 | * frame (PS-Poll or uAPSD) or a non-bufferable MMPDU and must | |
467 | * be sent although the station is in powersave mode. | |
ad5351db JB |
468 | * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_MORE_FRAMES: More frames will be passed to the |
469 | * transmit function after the current frame, this can be used | |
470 | * by drivers to kick the DMA queue only if unset or when the | |
471 | * queue gets full. | |
c6fcf6bc JB |
472 | * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_RETRANSMISSION: This frame is being retransmitted |
473 | * after TX status because the destination was asleep, it must not | |
474 | * be modified again (no seqno assignment, crypto, etc.) | |
1672c0e3 JB |
475 | * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_MLME_CONN_TX: This frame was transmitted by the MLME |
476 | * code for connection establishment, this indicates that its status | |
477 | * should kick the MLME state machine. | |
026331c4 JM |
478 | * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_NL80211_FRAME_TX: Frame was requested through nl80211 |
479 | * MLME command (internal to mac80211 to figure out whether to send TX | |
480 | * status to user space) | |
0a56bd0a | 481 | * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_LDPC: tells the driver to use LDPC for this frame |
f79d9bad FF |
482 | * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_STBC: Enables Space-Time Block Coding (STBC) for this |
483 | * frame and selects the maximum number of streams that it can use. | |
610dbc98 JB |
484 | * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_TX_OFFCHAN: Marks this packet to be transmitted on |
485 | * the off-channel channel when a remain-on-channel offload is done | |
486 | * in hardware -- normal packets still flow and are expected to be | |
487 | * handled properly by the device. | |
681d1190 JM |
488 | * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_TKIP_MIC_FAILURE: Marks this packet to be used for TKIP |
489 | * testing. It will be sent out with incorrect Michael MIC key to allow | |
490 | * TKIP countermeasures to be tested. | |
aad14ceb RM |
491 | * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_CCK_RATE: This frame will be sent at non CCK rate. |
492 | * This flag is actually used for management frame especially for P2P | |
493 | * frames not being sent at CCK rate in 2GHz band. | |
47086fc5 JB |
494 | * @IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP: This packet marks the end of service period, |
495 | * when its status is reported the service period ends. For frames in | |
496 | * an SP that mac80211 transmits, it is already set; for driver frames | |
deeaee19 JB |
497 | * the driver may set this flag. It is also used to do the same for |
498 | * PS-Poll responses. | |
b6f35301 RM |
499 | * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_USE_MINRATE: This frame will be sent at lowest rate. |
500 | * This flag is used to send nullfunc frame at minimum rate when | |
501 | * the nullfunc is used for connection monitoring purpose. | |
a26eb27a JB |
502 | * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_DONTFRAG: Don't fragment this packet even if it |
503 | * would be fragmented by size (this is optional, only used for | |
504 | * monitor injection). | |
d6d23de2 FF |
505 | * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_PS_RESPONSE: This frame is a response to a poll |
506 | * frame (PS-Poll or uAPSD). | |
eb7d3066 CL |
507 | * |
508 | * Note: If you have to add new flags to the enumeration, then don't | |
509 | * forget to update %IEEE80211_TX_TEMPORARY_FLAGS when necessary. | |
11f4b1ce | 510 | */ |
af61a165 | 511 | enum mac80211_tx_info_flags { |
e039fa4a | 512 | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_REQ_TX_STATUS = BIT(0), |
e6a9854b JB |
513 | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_ASSIGN_SEQ = BIT(1), |
514 | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK = BIT(2), | |
515 | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_CLEAR_PS_FILT = BIT(3), | |
516 | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_FIRST_FRAGMENT = BIT(4), | |
517 | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_SEND_AFTER_DTIM = BIT(5), | |
518 | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_AMPDU = BIT(6), | |
519 | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_INJECTED = BIT(7), | |
520 | IEEE80211_TX_STAT_TX_FILTERED = BIT(8), | |
521 | IEEE80211_TX_STAT_ACK = BIT(9), | |
522 | IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU = BIT(10), | |
523 | IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU_NO_BACK = BIT(11), | |
524 | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_RATE_CTRL_PROBE = BIT(12), | |
6c17b77b | 525 | IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_OFFCHAN_TX_OK = BIT(13), |
cd8ffc80 | 526 | IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_NEED_TXPROCESSING = BIT(14), |
8f77f384 | 527 | IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_RETRIED = BIT(15), |
3b8d81e0 | 528 | IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_DONT_ENCRYPT = BIT(16), |
02f2f1a9 | 529 | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER = BIT(17), |
ad5351db | 530 | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_MORE_FRAMES = BIT(18), |
c6fcf6bc | 531 | IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_RETRANSMISSION = BIT(19), |
1672c0e3 | 532 | IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_MLME_CONN_TX = BIT(20), |
026331c4 | 533 | IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_NL80211_FRAME_TX = BIT(21), |
0a56bd0a | 534 | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_LDPC = BIT(22), |
f79d9bad | 535 | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_STBC = BIT(23) | BIT(24), |
21f83589 | 536 | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_TX_OFFCHAN = BIT(25), |
681d1190 | 537 | IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_TKIP_MIC_FAILURE = BIT(26), |
aad14ceb | 538 | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_CCK_RATE = BIT(27), |
47086fc5 | 539 | IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP = BIT(28), |
b6f35301 | 540 | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_USE_MINRATE = BIT(29), |
a26eb27a | 541 | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_DONTFRAG = BIT(30), |
d6d23de2 | 542 | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_PS_RESPONSE = BIT(31), |
11f4b1ce RR |
543 | }; |
544 | ||
abe37c4b JB |
545 | #define IEEE80211_TX_CTL_STBC_SHIFT 23 |
546 | ||
af61a165 JB |
547 | /** |
548 | * enum mac80211_tx_control_flags - flags to describe transmit control | |
549 | * | |
550 | * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_PORT_CTRL_PROTO: this frame is a port control | |
551 | * protocol frame (e.g. EAP) | |
552 | * | |
553 | * These flags are used in tx_info->control.flags. | |
554 | */ | |
555 | enum mac80211_tx_control_flags { | |
556 | IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_PORT_CTRL_PROTO = BIT(0), | |
557 | }; | |
558 | ||
eb7d3066 CL |
559 | /* |
560 | * This definition is used as a mask to clear all temporary flags, which are | |
561 | * set by the tx handlers for each transmission attempt by the mac80211 stack. | |
562 | */ | |
563 | #define IEEE80211_TX_TEMPORARY_FLAGS (IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK | \ | |
564 | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_CLEAR_PS_FILT | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_FIRST_FRAGMENT | \ | |
565 | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_SEND_AFTER_DTIM | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_AMPDU | \ | |
566 | IEEE80211_TX_STAT_TX_FILTERED | IEEE80211_TX_STAT_ACK | \ | |
567 | IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU | IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU_NO_BACK | \ | |
02f2f1a9 | 568 | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_RATE_CTRL_PROBE | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER | \ |
eb7d3066 | 569 | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_MORE_FRAMES | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_LDPC | \ |
47086fc5 | 570 | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_STBC | IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP) |
eb7d3066 | 571 | |
2134e7e7 S |
572 | /** |
573 | * enum mac80211_rate_control_flags - per-rate flags set by the | |
574 | * Rate Control algorithm. | |
575 | * | |
576 | * These flags are set by the Rate control algorithm for each rate during tx, | |
577 | * in the @flags member of struct ieee80211_tx_rate. | |
578 | * | |
579 | * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_RTS_CTS: Use RTS/CTS exchange for this rate. | |
580 | * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_CTS_PROTECT: CTS-to-self protection is required. | |
581 | * This is set if the current BSS requires ERP protection. | |
582 | * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_SHORT_PREAMBLE: Use short preamble. | |
583 | * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_MCS: HT rate. | |
8bc83c24 JB |
584 | * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_VHT_MCS: VHT MCS rate, in this case the idx field is split |
585 | * into a higher 4 bits (Nss) and lower 4 bits (MCS number) | |
2134e7e7 S |
586 | * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_GREEN_FIELD: Indicates whether this rate should be used in |
587 | * Greenfield mode. | |
588 | * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_40_MHZ_WIDTH: Indicates if the Channel Width should be 40 MHz. | |
8bc83c24 JB |
589 | * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_80_MHZ_WIDTH: Indicates 80 MHz transmission |
590 | * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_160_MHZ_WIDTH: Indicates 160 MHz transmission | |
591 | * (80+80 isn't supported yet) | |
2134e7e7 S |
592 | * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_DUP_DATA: The frame should be transmitted on both of the |
593 | * adjacent 20 MHz channels, if the current channel type is | |
594 | * NL80211_CHAN_HT40MINUS or NL80211_CHAN_HT40PLUS. | |
595 | * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_SHORT_GI: Short Guard interval should be used for this rate. | |
596 | */ | |
e6a9854b JB |
597 | enum mac80211_rate_control_flags { |
598 | IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_RTS_CTS = BIT(0), | |
599 | IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_CTS_PROTECT = BIT(1), | |
600 | IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_SHORT_PREAMBLE = BIT(2), | |
601 | ||
8bc83c24 | 602 | /* rate index is an HT/VHT MCS instead of an index */ |
e6a9854b JB |
603 | IEEE80211_TX_RC_MCS = BIT(3), |
604 | IEEE80211_TX_RC_GREEN_FIELD = BIT(4), | |
605 | IEEE80211_TX_RC_40_MHZ_WIDTH = BIT(5), | |
606 | IEEE80211_TX_RC_DUP_DATA = BIT(6), | |
607 | IEEE80211_TX_RC_SHORT_GI = BIT(7), | |
8bc83c24 JB |
608 | IEEE80211_TX_RC_VHT_MCS = BIT(8), |
609 | IEEE80211_TX_RC_80_MHZ_WIDTH = BIT(9), | |
610 | IEEE80211_TX_RC_160_MHZ_WIDTH = BIT(10), | |
e6a9854b JB |
611 | }; |
612 | ||
613 | ||
614 | /* there are 40 bytes if you don't need the rateset to be kept */ | |
615 | #define IEEE80211_TX_INFO_DRIVER_DATA_SIZE 40 | |
8318d78a | 616 | |
e6a9854b JB |
617 | /* if you do need the rateset, then you have less space */ |
618 | #define IEEE80211_TX_INFO_RATE_DRIVER_DATA_SIZE 24 | |
1c014420 | 619 | |
e6a9854b | 620 | /* maximum number of rate stages */ |
e3e1a0bc | 621 | #define IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES 4 |
870abdf6 | 622 | |
0d528d85 FF |
623 | /* maximum number of rate table entries */ |
624 | #define IEEE80211_TX_RATE_TABLE_SIZE 4 | |
625 | ||
870abdf6 | 626 | /** |
e6a9854b | 627 | * struct ieee80211_tx_rate - rate selection/status |
870abdf6 | 628 | * |
e6a9854b JB |
629 | * @idx: rate index to attempt to send with |
630 | * @flags: rate control flags (&enum mac80211_rate_control_flags) | |
e25cf4a6 | 631 | * @count: number of tries in this rate before going to the next rate |
e6a9854b JB |
632 | * |
633 | * A value of -1 for @idx indicates an invalid rate and, if used | |
634 | * in an array of retry rates, that no more rates should be tried. | |
635 | * | |
636 | * When used for transmit status reporting, the driver should | |
637 | * always report the rate along with the flags it used. | |
c555b9b3 JB |
638 | * |
639 | * &struct ieee80211_tx_info contains an array of these structs | |
640 | * in the control information, and it will be filled by the rate | |
641 | * control algorithm according to what should be sent. For example, | |
642 | * if this array contains, in the format { <idx>, <count> } the | |
643 | * information | |
644 | * { 3, 2 }, { 2, 2 }, { 1, 4 }, { -1, 0 }, { -1, 0 } | |
645 | * then this means that the frame should be transmitted | |
646 | * up to twice at rate 3, up to twice at rate 2, and up to four | |
647 | * times at rate 1 if it doesn't get acknowledged. Say it gets | |
648 | * acknowledged by the peer after the fifth attempt, the status | |
649 | * information should then contain | |
650 | * { 3, 2 }, { 2, 2 }, { 1, 1 }, { -1, 0 } ... | |
651 | * since it was transmitted twice at rate 3, twice at rate 2 | |
652 | * and once at rate 1 after which we received an acknowledgement. | |
870abdf6 | 653 | */ |
e6a9854b JB |
654 | struct ieee80211_tx_rate { |
655 | s8 idx; | |
8bc83c24 JB |
656 | u16 count:5, |
657 | flags:11; | |
3f30fc15 | 658 | } __packed; |
870abdf6 | 659 | |
8bc83c24 JB |
660 | #define IEEE80211_MAX_TX_RETRY 31 |
661 | ||
662 | static inline void ieee80211_rate_set_vht(struct ieee80211_tx_rate *rate, | |
663 | u8 mcs, u8 nss) | |
664 | { | |
665 | WARN_ON(mcs & ~0xF); | |
6bc8312f KB |
666 | WARN_ON((nss - 1) & ~0x7); |
667 | rate->idx = ((nss - 1) << 4) | mcs; | |
8bc83c24 JB |
668 | } |
669 | ||
670 | static inline u8 | |
671 | ieee80211_rate_get_vht_mcs(const struct ieee80211_tx_rate *rate) | |
672 | { | |
673 | return rate->idx & 0xF; | |
674 | } | |
675 | ||
676 | static inline u8 | |
677 | ieee80211_rate_get_vht_nss(const struct ieee80211_tx_rate *rate) | |
678 | { | |
6bc8312f | 679 | return (rate->idx >> 4) + 1; |
8bc83c24 JB |
680 | } |
681 | ||
e039fa4a JB |
682 | /** |
683 | * struct ieee80211_tx_info - skb transmit information | |
684 | * | |
685 | * This structure is placed in skb->cb for three uses: | |
686 | * (1) mac80211 TX control - mac80211 tells the driver what to do | |
687 | * (2) driver internal use (if applicable) | |
688 | * (3) TX status information - driver tells mac80211 what happened | |
689 | * | |
690 | * @flags: transmit info flags, defined above | |
e6a9854b | 691 | * @band: the band to transmit on (use for checking for races) |
3a25a8c8 | 692 | * @hw_queue: HW queue to put the frame on, skb_get_queue_mapping() gives the AC |
a729cff8 | 693 | * @ack_frame_id: internal frame ID for TX status, used internally |
6ef307bc RD |
694 | * @control: union for control data |
695 | * @status: union for status data | |
696 | * @driver_data: array of driver_data pointers | |
599bf6a4 | 697 | * @ampdu_ack_len: number of acked aggregated frames. |
93d95b12 | 698 | * relevant only if IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU was set. |
599bf6a4 | 699 | * @ampdu_len: number of aggregated frames. |
93d95b12 | 700 | * relevant only if IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU was set. |
e039fa4a | 701 | * @ack_signal: signal strength of the ACK frame |
1c014420 | 702 | */ |
e039fa4a JB |
703 | struct ieee80211_tx_info { |
704 | /* common information */ | |
705 | u32 flags; | |
706 | u8 band; | |
e6a9854b | 707 | |
3a25a8c8 | 708 | u8 hw_queue; |
2e92e6f2 | 709 | |
a729cff8 | 710 | u16 ack_frame_id; |
e039fa4a JB |
711 | |
712 | union { | |
713 | struct { | |
e6a9854b JB |
714 | union { |
715 | /* rate control */ | |
716 | struct { | |
717 | struct ieee80211_tx_rate rates[ | |
718 | IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES]; | |
719 | s8 rts_cts_rate_idx; | |
991fec09 FF |
720 | u8 use_rts:1; |
721 | u8 use_cts_prot:1; | |
0d528d85 FF |
722 | u8 short_preamble:1; |
723 | u8 skip_table:1; | |
991fec09 | 724 | /* 2 bytes free */ |
e6a9854b JB |
725 | }; |
726 | /* only needed before rate control */ | |
727 | unsigned long jiffies; | |
728 | }; | |
25d834e1 | 729 | /* NB: vif can be NULL for injected frames */ |
e039fa4a JB |
730 | struct ieee80211_vif *vif; |
731 | struct ieee80211_key_conf *hw_key; | |
af61a165 JB |
732 | u32 flags; |
733 | /* 4 bytes free */ | |
e039fa4a JB |
734 | } control; |
735 | struct { | |
e6a9854b | 736 | struct ieee80211_tx_rate rates[IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES]; |
a0f995a5 | 737 | s32 ack_signal; |
e3e1a0bc | 738 | u8 ampdu_ack_len; |
599bf6a4 | 739 | u8 ampdu_len; |
d748b464 | 740 | u8 antenna; |
a0f995a5 | 741 | void *status_driver_data[21 / sizeof(void *)]; |
e039fa4a | 742 | } status; |
e6a9854b JB |
743 | struct { |
744 | struct ieee80211_tx_rate driver_rates[ | |
745 | IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES]; | |
0d528d85 FF |
746 | u8 pad[4]; |
747 | ||
e6a9854b JB |
748 | void *rate_driver_data[ |
749 | IEEE80211_TX_INFO_RATE_DRIVER_DATA_SIZE / sizeof(void *)]; | |
750 | }; | |
751 | void *driver_data[ | |
752 | IEEE80211_TX_INFO_DRIVER_DATA_SIZE / sizeof(void *)]; | |
e039fa4a | 753 | }; |
f0706e82 JB |
754 | }; |
755 | ||
79f460ca | 756 | /** |
bdfbe804 | 757 | * struct ieee80211_sched_scan_ies - scheduled scan IEs |
79f460ca LC |
758 | * |
759 | * This structure is used to pass the appropriate IEs to be used in scheduled | |
760 | * scans for all bands. It contains both the IEs passed from the userspace | |
761 | * and the ones generated by mac80211. | |
762 | * | |
763 | * @ie: array with the IEs for each supported band | |
764 | * @len: array with the total length of the IEs for each band | |
765 | */ | |
766 | struct ieee80211_sched_scan_ies { | |
767 | u8 *ie[IEEE80211_NUM_BANDS]; | |
768 | size_t len[IEEE80211_NUM_BANDS]; | |
769 | }; | |
770 | ||
c56ef672 DS |
771 | /** |
772 | * struct ieee80211_scan_ies - descriptors for different blocks of IEs | |
773 | * | |
774 | * This structure is used to point to different blocks of IEs in HW scan. | |
775 | * These blocks contain the IEs passed by userspace and the ones generated | |
776 | * by mac80211. | |
777 | * | |
778 | * @ies: pointers to band specific IEs. | |
779 | * @len: lengths of band_specific IEs. | |
780 | * @common_ies: IEs for all bands (especially vendor specific ones) | |
781 | * @common_ie_len: length of the common_ies | |
782 | */ | |
783 | struct ieee80211_scan_ies { | |
784 | const u8 *ies[IEEE80211_NUM_BANDS]; | |
785 | size_t len[IEEE80211_NUM_BANDS]; | |
786 | const u8 *common_ies; | |
787 | size_t common_ie_len; | |
788 | }; | |
789 | ||
790 | ||
e039fa4a JB |
791 | static inline struct ieee80211_tx_info *IEEE80211_SKB_CB(struct sk_buff *skb) |
792 | { | |
793 | return (struct ieee80211_tx_info *)skb->cb; | |
794 | } | |
7ac1bd6a | 795 | |
f1d58c25 JB |
796 | static inline struct ieee80211_rx_status *IEEE80211_SKB_RXCB(struct sk_buff *skb) |
797 | { | |
798 | return (struct ieee80211_rx_status *)skb->cb; | |
799 | } | |
800 | ||
e6a9854b JB |
801 | /** |
802 | * ieee80211_tx_info_clear_status - clear TX status | |
803 | * | |
804 | * @info: The &struct ieee80211_tx_info to be cleared. | |
805 | * | |
806 | * When the driver passes an skb back to mac80211, it must report | |
807 | * a number of things in TX status. This function clears everything | |
808 | * in the TX status but the rate control information (it does clear | |
809 | * the count since you need to fill that in anyway). | |
810 | * | |
811 | * NOTE: You can only use this function if you do NOT use | |
812 | * info->driver_data! Use info->rate_driver_data | |
813 | * instead if you need only the less space that allows. | |
814 | */ | |
815 | static inline void | |
816 | ieee80211_tx_info_clear_status(struct ieee80211_tx_info *info) | |
817 | { | |
818 | int i; | |
819 | ||
820 | BUILD_BUG_ON(offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, status.rates) != | |
821 | offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, control.rates)); | |
822 | BUILD_BUG_ON(offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, status.rates) != | |
823 | offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, driver_rates)); | |
824 | BUILD_BUG_ON(offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, status.rates) != 8); | |
825 | /* clear the rate counts */ | |
826 | for (i = 0; i < IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES; i++) | |
827 | info->status.rates[i].count = 0; | |
828 | ||
829 | BUILD_BUG_ON( | |
e3e1a0bc | 830 | offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, status.ack_signal) != 20); |
e6a9854b JB |
831 | memset(&info->status.ampdu_ack_len, 0, |
832 | sizeof(struct ieee80211_tx_info) - | |
833 | offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, status.ampdu_ack_len)); | |
834 | } | |
835 | ||
7ac1bd6a JB |
836 | |
837 | /** | |
838 | * enum mac80211_rx_flags - receive flags | |
839 | * | |
840 | * These flags are used with the @flag member of &struct ieee80211_rx_status. | |
841 | * @RX_FLAG_MMIC_ERROR: Michael MIC error was reported on this frame. | |
842 | * Use together with %RX_FLAG_MMIC_STRIPPED. | |
843 | * @RX_FLAG_DECRYPTED: This frame was decrypted in hardware. | |
7ac1bd6a JB |
844 | * @RX_FLAG_MMIC_STRIPPED: the Michael MIC is stripped off this frame, |
845 | * verification has been done by the hardware. | |
846 | * @RX_FLAG_IV_STRIPPED: The IV/ICV are stripped from this frame. | |
847 | * If this flag is set, the stack cannot do any replay detection | |
848 | * hence the driver or hardware will have to do that. | |
72abd81b JB |
849 | * @RX_FLAG_FAILED_FCS_CRC: Set this flag if the FCS check failed on |
850 | * the frame. | |
851 | * @RX_FLAG_FAILED_PLCP_CRC: Set this flag if the PCLP check failed on | |
852 | * the frame. | |
f4bda337 | 853 | * @RX_FLAG_MACTIME_START: The timestamp passed in the RX status (@mactime |
6ebacbb7 JB |
854 | * field) is valid and contains the time the first symbol of the MPDU |
855 | * was received. This is useful in monitor mode and for proper IBSS | |
856 | * merging. | |
f4bda337 TP |
857 | * @RX_FLAG_MACTIME_END: The timestamp passed in the RX status (@mactime |
858 | * field) is valid and contains the time the last symbol of the MPDU | |
859 | * (including FCS) was received. | |
b4f28bbb | 860 | * @RX_FLAG_SHORTPRE: Short preamble was used for this frame |
0fb8ca45 | 861 | * @RX_FLAG_HT: HT MCS was used and rate_idx is MCS index |
5614618e | 862 | * @RX_FLAG_VHT: VHT MCS was used and rate_index is MCS index |
0fb8ca45 JM |
863 | * @RX_FLAG_40MHZ: HT40 (40 MHz) was used |
864 | * @RX_FLAG_SHORT_GI: Short guard interval was used | |
fe8431f8 FF |
865 | * @RX_FLAG_NO_SIGNAL_VAL: The signal strength value is not present. |
866 | * Valid only for data frames (mainly A-MPDU) | |
ac55d2fe JB |
867 | * @RX_FLAG_HT_GF: This frame was received in a HT-greenfield transmission, if |
868 | * the driver fills this value it should add %IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_MCS_HAVE_FMT | |
869 | * to hw.radiotap_mcs_details to advertise that fact | |
4c298677 JB |
870 | * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DETAILS: A-MPDU details are known, in particular the reference |
871 | * number (@ampdu_reference) must be populated and be a distinct number for | |
872 | * each A-MPDU | |
873 | * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_REPORT_ZEROLEN: driver reports 0-length subframes | |
874 | * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_IS_ZEROLEN: This is a zero-length subframe, for | |
875 | * monitoring purposes only | |
876 | * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_LAST_KNOWN: last subframe is known, should be set on all | |
877 | * subframes of a single A-MPDU | |
878 | * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_IS_LAST: this subframe is the last subframe of the A-MPDU | |
879 | * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DELIM_CRC_ERROR: A delimiter CRC error has been detected | |
880 | * on this subframe | |
881 | * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DELIM_CRC_KNOWN: The delimiter CRC field is known (the CRC | |
882 | * is stored in the @ampdu_delimiter_crc field) | |
63c361f5 | 883 | * @RX_FLAG_LDPC: LDPC was used |
786677d1 | 884 | * @RX_FLAG_STBC_MASK: STBC 2 bit bitmask. 1 - Nss=1, 2 - Nss=2, 3 - Nss=3 |
a5e70697 SW |
885 | * @RX_FLAG_10MHZ: 10 MHz (half channel) was used |
886 | * @RX_FLAG_5MHZ: 5 MHz (quarter channel) was used | |
0cfcefef MK |
887 | * @RX_FLAG_AMSDU_MORE: Some drivers may prefer to report separate A-MSDU |
888 | * subframes instead of a one huge frame for performance reasons. | |
889 | * All, but the last MSDU from an A-MSDU should have this flag set. E.g. | |
890 | * if an A-MSDU has 3 frames, the first 2 must have the flag set, while | |
891 | * the 3rd (last) one must not have this flag set. The flag is used to | |
892 | * deal with retransmission/duplication recovery properly since A-MSDU | |
893 | * subframes share the same sequence number. Reported subframes can be | |
894 | * either regular MSDU or singly A-MSDUs. Subframes must not be | |
895 | * interleaved with other frames. | |
7ac1bd6a JB |
896 | */ |
897 | enum mac80211_rx_flags { | |
4c298677 JB |
898 | RX_FLAG_MMIC_ERROR = BIT(0), |
899 | RX_FLAG_DECRYPTED = BIT(1), | |
900 | RX_FLAG_MMIC_STRIPPED = BIT(3), | |
901 | RX_FLAG_IV_STRIPPED = BIT(4), | |
902 | RX_FLAG_FAILED_FCS_CRC = BIT(5), | |
903 | RX_FLAG_FAILED_PLCP_CRC = BIT(6), | |
f4bda337 | 904 | RX_FLAG_MACTIME_START = BIT(7), |
4c298677 JB |
905 | RX_FLAG_SHORTPRE = BIT(8), |
906 | RX_FLAG_HT = BIT(9), | |
907 | RX_FLAG_40MHZ = BIT(10), | |
908 | RX_FLAG_SHORT_GI = BIT(11), | |
909 | RX_FLAG_NO_SIGNAL_VAL = BIT(12), | |
910 | RX_FLAG_HT_GF = BIT(13), | |
911 | RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DETAILS = BIT(14), | |
912 | RX_FLAG_AMPDU_REPORT_ZEROLEN = BIT(15), | |
913 | RX_FLAG_AMPDU_IS_ZEROLEN = BIT(16), | |
914 | RX_FLAG_AMPDU_LAST_KNOWN = BIT(17), | |
915 | RX_FLAG_AMPDU_IS_LAST = BIT(18), | |
916 | RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DELIM_CRC_ERROR = BIT(19), | |
917 | RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DELIM_CRC_KNOWN = BIT(20), | |
f4bda337 | 918 | RX_FLAG_MACTIME_END = BIT(21), |
5614618e | 919 | RX_FLAG_VHT = BIT(22), |
63c361f5 | 920 | RX_FLAG_LDPC = BIT(23), |
786677d1 | 921 | RX_FLAG_STBC_MASK = BIT(26) | BIT(27), |
a5e70697 SW |
922 | RX_FLAG_10MHZ = BIT(28), |
923 | RX_FLAG_5MHZ = BIT(29), | |
0cfcefef | 924 | RX_FLAG_AMSDU_MORE = BIT(30), |
7ac1bd6a JB |
925 | }; |
926 | ||
786677d1 OR |
927 | #define RX_FLAG_STBC_SHIFT 26 |
928 | ||
1b8d242a EG |
929 | /** |
930 | * enum mac80211_rx_vht_flags - receive VHT flags | |
931 | * | |
932 | * These flags are used with the @vht_flag member of | |
933 | * &struct ieee80211_rx_status. | |
934 | * @RX_VHT_FLAG_80MHZ: 80 MHz was used | |
935 | * @RX_VHT_FLAG_80P80MHZ: 80+80 MHz was used | |
936 | * @RX_VHT_FLAG_160MHZ: 160 MHz was used | |
fb378c23 | 937 | * @RX_VHT_FLAG_BF: packet was beamformed |
1b8d242a EG |
938 | */ |
939 | enum mac80211_rx_vht_flags { | |
940 | RX_VHT_FLAG_80MHZ = BIT(0), | |
941 | RX_VHT_FLAG_80P80MHZ = BIT(1), | |
942 | RX_VHT_FLAG_160MHZ = BIT(2), | |
fb378c23 | 943 | RX_VHT_FLAG_BF = BIT(3), |
1b8d242a EG |
944 | }; |
945 | ||
7ac1bd6a JB |
946 | /** |
947 | * struct ieee80211_rx_status - receive status | |
948 | * | |
949 | * The low-level driver should provide this information (the subset | |
950 | * supported by hardware) to the 802.11 code with each received | |
f1d58c25 | 951 | * frame, in the skb's control buffer (cb). |
566bfe5a | 952 | * |
c132bec3 BR |
953 | * @mactime: value in microseconds of the 64-bit Time Synchronization Function |
954 | * (TSF) timer when the first data symbol (MPDU) arrived at the hardware. | |
8c358bcd JB |
955 | * @device_timestamp: arbitrary timestamp for the device, mac80211 doesn't use |
956 | * it but can store it and pass it back to the driver for synchronisation | |
8318d78a | 957 | * @band: the active band when this frame was received |
7ac1bd6a | 958 | * @freq: frequency the radio was tuned to when receiving this frame, in MHz |
566bfe5a BR |
959 | * @signal: signal strength when receiving this frame, either in dBm, in dB or |
960 | * unspecified depending on the hardware capabilities flags | |
961 | * @IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_* | |
ef0621e8 FF |
962 | * @chains: bitmask of receive chains for which separate signal strength |
963 | * values were filled. | |
964 | * @chain_signal: per-chain signal strength, in dBm (unlike @signal, doesn't | |
965 | * support dB or unspecified units) | |
7ac1bd6a | 966 | * @antenna: antenna used |
0fb8ca45 | 967 | * @rate_idx: index of data rate into band's supported rates or MCS index if |
5614618e JB |
968 | * HT or VHT is used (%RX_FLAG_HT/%RX_FLAG_VHT) |
969 | * @vht_nss: number of streams (VHT only) | |
7ac1bd6a | 970 | * @flag: %RX_FLAG_* |
1b8d242a | 971 | * @vht_flag: %RX_VHT_FLAG_* |
554891e6 | 972 | * @rx_flags: internal RX flags for mac80211 |
4c298677 JB |
973 | * @ampdu_reference: A-MPDU reference number, must be a different value for |
974 | * each A-MPDU but the same for each subframe within one A-MPDU | |
975 | * @ampdu_delimiter_crc: A-MPDU delimiter CRC | |
7ac1bd6a | 976 | */ |
f0706e82 JB |
977 | struct ieee80211_rx_status { |
978 | u64 mactime; | |
8c358bcd | 979 | u32 device_timestamp; |
4c298677 JB |
980 | u32 ampdu_reference; |
981 | u32 flag; | |
30f42292 | 982 | u16 freq; |
1b8d242a | 983 | u8 vht_flag; |
30f42292 | 984 | u8 rate_idx; |
5614618e | 985 | u8 vht_nss; |
30f42292 JB |
986 | u8 rx_flags; |
987 | u8 band; | |
988 | u8 antenna; | |
989 | s8 signal; | |
ef0621e8 FF |
990 | u8 chains; |
991 | s8 chain_signal[IEEE80211_MAX_CHAINS]; | |
4c298677 | 992 | u8 ampdu_delimiter_crc; |
f0706e82 JB |
993 | }; |
994 | ||
6b301cdf JB |
995 | /** |
996 | * enum ieee80211_conf_flags - configuration flags | |
997 | * | |
998 | * Flags to define PHY configuration options | |
999 | * | |
0869aea0 JB |
1000 | * @IEEE80211_CONF_MONITOR: there's a monitor interface present -- use this |
1001 | * to determine for example whether to calculate timestamps for packets | |
1002 | * or not, do not use instead of filter flags! | |
c99445b1 KV |
1003 | * @IEEE80211_CONF_PS: Enable 802.11 power save mode (managed mode only). |
1004 | * This is the power save mode defined by IEEE 802.11-2007 section 11.2, | |
1005 | * meaning that the hardware still wakes up for beacons, is able to | |
1006 | * transmit frames and receive the possible acknowledgment frames. | |
1007 | * Not to be confused with hardware specific wakeup/sleep states, | |
1008 | * driver is responsible for that. See the section "Powersave support" | |
1009 | * for more. | |
5cff20e6 JB |
1010 | * @IEEE80211_CONF_IDLE: The device is running, but idle; if the flag is set |
1011 | * the driver should be prepared to handle configuration requests but | |
1012 | * may turn the device off as much as possible. Typically, this flag will | |
1013 | * be set when an interface is set UP but not associated or scanning, but | |
1014 | * it can also be unset in that case when monitor interfaces are active. | |
45521245 FF |
1015 | * @IEEE80211_CONF_OFFCHANNEL: The device is currently not on its main |
1016 | * operating channel. | |
6b301cdf JB |
1017 | */ |
1018 | enum ieee80211_conf_flags { | |
0869aea0 | 1019 | IEEE80211_CONF_MONITOR = (1<<0), |
ae5eb026 | 1020 | IEEE80211_CONF_PS = (1<<1), |
5cff20e6 | 1021 | IEEE80211_CONF_IDLE = (1<<2), |
45521245 | 1022 | IEEE80211_CONF_OFFCHANNEL = (1<<3), |
6b301cdf | 1023 | }; |
f0706e82 | 1024 | |
7a5158ef | 1025 | |
e8975581 JB |
1026 | /** |
1027 | * enum ieee80211_conf_changed - denotes which configuration changed | |
1028 | * | |
e8975581 | 1029 | * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_LISTEN_INTERVAL: the listen interval changed |
0869aea0 | 1030 | * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_MONITOR: the monitor flag changed |
e255d5eb | 1031 | * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_PS: the PS flag or dynamic PS timeout changed |
e8975581 | 1032 | * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_POWER: the TX power changed |
4797938c | 1033 | * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_CHANNEL: the channel/channel_type changed |
9124b077 | 1034 | * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_RETRY_LIMITS: retry limits changed |
5cff20e6 | 1035 | * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_IDLE: Idle flag changed |
0f78231b | 1036 | * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_SMPS: Spatial multiplexing powersave mode changed |
04ecd257 JB |
1037 | * Note that this is only valid if channel contexts are not used, |
1038 | * otherwise each channel context has the number of chains listed. | |
e8975581 JB |
1039 | */ |
1040 | enum ieee80211_conf_changed { | |
0f78231b | 1041 | IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_SMPS = BIT(1), |
e8975581 | 1042 | IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_LISTEN_INTERVAL = BIT(2), |
0869aea0 | 1043 | IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_MONITOR = BIT(3), |
e8975581 | 1044 | IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_PS = BIT(4), |
e255d5eb JB |
1045 | IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_POWER = BIT(5), |
1046 | IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_CHANNEL = BIT(6), | |
1047 | IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_RETRY_LIMITS = BIT(7), | |
5cff20e6 | 1048 | IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_IDLE = BIT(8), |
e8975581 JB |
1049 | }; |
1050 | ||
0f78231b JB |
1051 | /** |
1052 | * enum ieee80211_smps_mode - spatial multiplexing power save mode | |
1053 | * | |
9d173fc5 KV |
1054 | * @IEEE80211_SMPS_AUTOMATIC: automatic |
1055 | * @IEEE80211_SMPS_OFF: off | |
1056 | * @IEEE80211_SMPS_STATIC: static | |
1057 | * @IEEE80211_SMPS_DYNAMIC: dynamic | |
1058 | * @IEEE80211_SMPS_NUM_MODES: internal, don't use | |
0f78231b JB |
1059 | */ |
1060 | enum ieee80211_smps_mode { | |
1061 | IEEE80211_SMPS_AUTOMATIC, | |
1062 | IEEE80211_SMPS_OFF, | |
1063 | IEEE80211_SMPS_STATIC, | |
1064 | IEEE80211_SMPS_DYNAMIC, | |
1065 | ||
1066 | /* keep last */ | |
1067 | IEEE80211_SMPS_NUM_MODES, | |
1068 | }; | |
1069 | ||
f0706e82 JB |
1070 | /** |
1071 | * struct ieee80211_conf - configuration of the device | |
1072 | * | |
1073 | * This struct indicates how the driver shall configure the hardware. | |
1074 | * | |
04fe2037 JB |
1075 | * @flags: configuration flags defined above |
1076 | * | |
ea95bba4 | 1077 | * @listen_interval: listen interval in units of beacon interval |
9ccebe61 | 1078 | * @max_sleep_period: the maximum number of beacon intervals to sleep for |
04fe2037 JB |
1079 | * before checking the beacon for a TIM bit (managed mode only); this |
1080 | * value will be only achievable between DTIM frames, the hardware | |
1081 | * needs to check for the multicast traffic bit in DTIM beacons. | |
1082 | * This variable is valid only when the CONF_PS flag is set. | |
56007a02 JB |
1083 | * @ps_dtim_period: The DTIM period of the AP we're connected to, for use |
1084 | * in power saving. Power saving will not be enabled until a beacon | |
1085 | * has been received and the DTIM period is known. | |
04fe2037 JB |
1086 | * @dynamic_ps_timeout: The dynamic powersave timeout (in ms), see the |
1087 | * powersave documentation below. This variable is valid only when | |
1088 | * the CONF_PS flag is set. | |
1089 | * | |
1ea6f9c0 JB |
1090 | * @power_level: requested transmit power (in dBm), backward compatibility |
1091 | * value only that is set to the minimum of all interfaces | |
04fe2037 | 1092 | * |
675a0b04 | 1093 | * @chandef: the channel definition to tune to |
164eb02d | 1094 | * @radar_enabled: whether radar detection is enabled |
04fe2037 | 1095 | * |
9124b077 | 1096 | * @long_frame_max_tx_count: Maximum number of transmissions for a "long" frame |
ad24b0da JB |
1097 | * (a frame not RTS protected), called "dot11LongRetryLimit" in 802.11, |
1098 | * but actually means the number of transmissions not the number of retries | |
9124b077 | 1099 | * @short_frame_max_tx_count: Maximum number of transmissions for a "short" |
ad24b0da JB |
1100 | * frame, called "dot11ShortRetryLimit" in 802.11, but actually means the |
1101 | * number of transmissions not the number of retries | |
0f78231b JB |
1102 | * |
1103 | * @smps_mode: spatial multiplexing powersave mode; note that | |
1104 | * %IEEE80211_SMPS_STATIC is used when the device is not | |
04ecd257 JB |
1105 | * configured for an HT channel. |
1106 | * Note that this is only valid if channel contexts are not used, | |
1107 | * otherwise each channel context has the number of chains listed. | |
f0706e82 JB |
1108 | */ |
1109 | struct ieee80211_conf { | |
6b301cdf | 1110 | u32 flags; |
ff616381 | 1111 | int power_level, dynamic_ps_timeout; |
9ccebe61 | 1112 | int max_sleep_period; |
10816d40 | 1113 | |
e8975581 | 1114 | u16 listen_interval; |
56007a02 | 1115 | u8 ps_dtim_period; |
e8975581 | 1116 | |
9124b077 JB |
1117 | u8 long_frame_max_tx_count, short_frame_max_tx_count; |
1118 | ||
675a0b04 | 1119 | struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef; |
164eb02d | 1120 | bool radar_enabled; |
0f78231b | 1121 | enum ieee80211_smps_mode smps_mode; |
f0706e82 JB |
1122 | }; |
1123 | ||
5ce6e438 JB |
1124 | /** |
1125 | * struct ieee80211_channel_switch - holds the channel switch data | |
1126 | * | |
1127 | * The information provided in this structure is required for channel switch | |
1128 | * operation. | |
1129 | * | |
1130 | * @timestamp: value in microseconds of the 64-bit Time Synchronization | |
1131 | * Function (TSF) timer when the frame containing the channel switch | |
1132 | * announcement was received. This is simply the rx.mactime parameter | |
1133 | * the driver passed into mac80211. | |
1134 | * @block_tx: Indicates whether transmission must be blocked before the | |
1135 | * scheduled channel switch, as indicated by the AP. | |
85220d71 | 1136 | * @chandef: the new channel to switch to |
5ce6e438 JB |
1137 | * @count: the number of TBTT's until the channel switch event |
1138 | */ | |
1139 | struct ieee80211_channel_switch { | |
1140 | u64 timestamp; | |
1141 | bool block_tx; | |
85220d71 | 1142 | struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef; |
5ce6e438 JB |
1143 | u8 count; |
1144 | }; | |
1145 | ||
c1288b12 JB |
1146 | /** |
1147 | * enum ieee80211_vif_flags - virtual interface flags | |
1148 | * | |
1149 | * @IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER: the device performs beacon filtering | |
1150 | * on this virtual interface to avoid unnecessary CPU wakeups | |
ea086359 JB |
1151 | * @IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_CQM_RSSI: the device can do connection quality |
1152 | * monitoring on this virtual interface -- i.e. it can monitor | |
1153 | * connection quality related parameters, such as the RSSI level and | |
1154 | * provide notifications if configured trigger levels are reached. | |
c1288b12 JB |
1155 | */ |
1156 | enum ieee80211_vif_flags { | |
1157 | IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER = BIT(0), | |
ea086359 | 1158 | IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_CQM_RSSI = BIT(1), |
c1288b12 JB |
1159 | }; |
1160 | ||
32bfd35d JB |
1161 | /** |
1162 | * struct ieee80211_vif - per-interface data | |
1163 | * | |
1164 | * Data in this structure is continually present for driver | |
1165 | * use during the life of a virtual interface. | |
1166 | * | |
51fb61e7 | 1167 | * @type: type of this virtual interface |
bda3933a JB |
1168 | * @bss_conf: BSS configuration for this interface, either our own |
1169 | * or the BSS we're associated to | |
47846c9b | 1170 | * @addr: address of this interface |
2ca27bcf JB |
1171 | * @p2p: indicates whether this AP or STA interface is a p2p |
1172 | * interface, i.e. a GO or p2p-sta respectively | |
59af6928 MK |
1173 | * @csa_active: marks whether a channel switch is going on. Internally it is |
1174 | * write-protected by sdata_lock and local->mtx so holding either is fine | |
1175 | * for read access. | |
c1288b12 JB |
1176 | * @driver_flags: flags/capabilities the driver has for this interface, |
1177 | * these need to be set (or cleared) when the interface is added | |
1178 | * or, if supported by the driver, the interface type is changed | |
1179 | * at runtime, mac80211 will never touch this field | |
3a25a8c8 JB |
1180 | * @hw_queue: hardware queue for each AC |
1181 | * @cab_queue: content-after-beacon (DTIM beacon really) queue, AP mode only | |
d01a1e65 MK |
1182 | * @chanctx_conf: The channel context this interface is assigned to, or %NULL |
1183 | * when it is not assigned. This pointer is RCU-protected due to the TX | |
1184 | * path needing to access it; even though the netdev carrier will always | |
1185 | * be off when it is %NULL there can still be races and packets could be | |
1186 | * processed after it switches back to %NULL. | |
ddbfe860 | 1187 | * @debugfs_dir: debugfs dentry, can be used by drivers to create own per |
ad24b0da | 1188 | * interface debug files. Note that it will be NULL for the virtual |
ddbfe860 | 1189 | * monitor interface (if that is requested.) |
32bfd35d JB |
1190 | * @drv_priv: data area for driver use, will always be aligned to |
1191 | * sizeof(void *). | |
1192 | */ | |
1193 | struct ieee80211_vif { | |
05c914fe | 1194 | enum nl80211_iftype type; |
bda3933a | 1195 | struct ieee80211_bss_conf bss_conf; |
47846c9b | 1196 | u8 addr[ETH_ALEN]; |
2ca27bcf | 1197 | bool p2p; |
73da7d5b | 1198 | bool csa_active; |
3a25a8c8 JB |
1199 | |
1200 | u8 cab_queue; | |
1201 | u8 hw_queue[IEEE80211_NUM_ACS]; | |
1202 | ||
d01a1e65 MK |
1203 | struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf __rcu *chanctx_conf; |
1204 | ||
c1288b12 | 1205 | u32 driver_flags; |
3a25a8c8 | 1206 | |
ddbfe860 SG |
1207 | #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS |
1208 | struct dentry *debugfs_dir; | |
1209 | #endif | |
1210 | ||
32bfd35d | 1211 | /* must be last */ |
1c06ef98 | 1212 | u8 drv_priv[0] __aligned(sizeof(void *)); |
32bfd35d JB |
1213 | }; |
1214 | ||
902acc78 JB |
1215 | static inline bool ieee80211_vif_is_mesh(struct ieee80211_vif *vif) |
1216 | { | |
1217 | #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_MESH | |
05c914fe | 1218 | return vif->type == NL80211_IFTYPE_MESH_POINT; |
902acc78 JB |
1219 | #endif |
1220 | return false; | |
1221 | } | |
1222 | ||
ad7e718c JB |
1223 | /** |
1224 | * wdev_to_ieee80211_vif - return a vif struct from a wdev | |
1225 | * @wdev: the wdev to get the vif for | |
1226 | * | |
1227 | * This can be used by mac80211 drivers with direct cfg80211 APIs | |
1228 | * (like the vendor commands) that get a wdev. | |
1229 | * | |
1230 | * Note that this function may return %NULL if the given wdev isn't | |
1231 | * associated with a vif that the driver knows about (e.g. monitor | |
1232 | * or AP_VLAN interfaces.) | |
1233 | */ | |
1234 | struct ieee80211_vif *wdev_to_ieee80211_vif(struct wireless_dev *wdev); | |
1235 | ||
7ac1bd6a JB |
1236 | /** |
1237 | * enum ieee80211_key_flags - key flags | |
1238 | * | |
1239 | * These flags are used for communication about keys between the driver | |
1240 | * and mac80211, with the @flags parameter of &struct ieee80211_key_conf. | |
1241 | * | |
7ac1bd6a JB |
1242 | * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV: This flag should be set by the |
1243 | * driver to indicate that it requires IV generation for this | |
1244 | * particular key. | |
1245 | * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIC: This flag should be set by | |
1246 | * the driver for a TKIP key if it requires Michael MIC | |
1247 | * generation in software. | |
c6adbd21 ID |
1248 | * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PAIRWISE: Set by mac80211, this flag indicates |
1249 | * that the key is pairwise rather then a shared key. | |
e548c49e | 1250 | * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_SW_MGMT_TX: This flag should be set by the driver for a |
1f7d77ab JM |
1251 | * CCMP key if it requires CCMP encryption of management frames (MFP) to |
1252 | * be done in software. | |
077a9154 | 1253 | * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PUT_IV_SPACE: This flag should be set by the driver |
ee70108f | 1254 | * if space should be prepared for the IV, but the IV |
077a9154 AN |
1255 | * itself should not be generated. Do not set together with |
1256 | * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV on the same key. | |
e548c49e JB |
1257 | * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_RX_MGMT: This key will be used to decrypt received |
1258 | * management frames. The flag can help drivers that have a hardware | |
1259 | * crypto implementation that doesn't deal with management frames | |
1260 | * properly by allowing them to not upload the keys to hardware and | |
1261 | * fall back to software crypto. Note that this flag deals only with | |
1262 | * RX, if your crypto engine can't deal with TX you can also set the | |
1263 | * %IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_SW_MGMT_TX flag to encrypt such frames in SW. | |
17d38fa8 MK |
1264 | * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV_MGMT: This flag should be set by the |
1265 | * driver for a CCMP key to indicate that is requires IV generation | |
1266 | * only for managment frames (MFP). | |
7848ba7d | 1267 | */ |
7ac1bd6a | 1268 | enum ieee80211_key_flags { |
17d38fa8 MK |
1269 | IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV_MGMT = BIT(0), |
1270 | IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV = BIT(1), | |
1271 | IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIC = BIT(2), | |
1272 | IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PAIRWISE = BIT(3), | |
1273 | IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_SW_MGMT_TX = BIT(4), | |
1274 | IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PUT_IV_SPACE = BIT(5), | |
1275 | IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_RX_MGMT = BIT(6), | |
7ac1bd6a | 1276 | }; |
11a843b7 | 1277 | |
7ac1bd6a JB |
1278 | /** |
1279 | * struct ieee80211_key_conf - key information | |
1280 | * | |
1281 | * This key information is given by mac80211 to the driver by | |
1282 | * the set_key() callback in &struct ieee80211_ops. | |
1283 | * | |
1284 | * @hw_key_idx: To be set by the driver, this is the key index the driver | |
1285 | * wants to be given when a frame is transmitted and needs to be | |
6a7664d4 | 1286 | * encrypted in hardware. |
97359d12 | 1287 | * @cipher: The key's cipher suite selector. |
7ac1bd6a JB |
1288 | * @flags: key flags, see &enum ieee80211_key_flags. |
1289 | * @keyidx: the key index (0-3) | |
1290 | * @keylen: key material length | |
ffd7891d LR |
1291 | * @key: key material. For ALG_TKIP the key is encoded as a 256-bit (32 byte) |
1292 | * data block: | |
1293 | * - Temporal Encryption Key (128 bits) | |
1294 | * - Temporal Authenticator Tx MIC Key (64 bits) | |
1295 | * - Temporal Authenticator Rx MIC Key (64 bits) | |
dc822b5d JB |
1296 | * @icv_len: The ICV length for this key type |
1297 | * @iv_len: The IV length for this key type | |
7ac1bd6a | 1298 | */ |
f0706e82 | 1299 | struct ieee80211_key_conf { |
97359d12 | 1300 | u32 cipher; |
76708dee FF |
1301 | u8 icv_len; |
1302 | u8 iv_len; | |
6a7664d4 | 1303 | u8 hw_key_idx; |
11a843b7 | 1304 | u8 flags; |
11a843b7 | 1305 | s8 keyidx; |
11a843b7 | 1306 | u8 keylen; |
f0706e82 JB |
1307 | u8 key[0]; |
1308 | }; | |
1309 | ||
2475b1cc MS |
1310 | /** |
1311 | * struct ieee80211_cipher_scheme - cipher scheme | |
1312 | * | |
1313 | * This structure contains a cipher scheme information defining | |
1314 | * the secure packet crypto handling. | |
1315 | * | |
1316 | * @cipher: a cipher suite selector | |
1317 | * @iftype: a cipher iftype bit mask indicating an allowed cipher usage | |
1318 | * @hdr_len: a length of a security header used the cipher | |
1319 | * @pn_len: a length of a packet number in the security header | |
1320 | * @pn_off: an offset of pn from the beginning of the security header | |
1321 | * @key_idx_off: an offset of key index byte in the security header | |
1322 | * @key_idx_mask: a bit mask of key_idx bits | |
1323 | * @key_idx_shift: a bit shift needed to get key_idx | |
1324 | * key_idx value calculation: | |
1325 | * (sec_header_base[key_idx_off] & key_idx_mask) >> key_idx_shift | |
1326 | * @mic_len: a mic length in bytes | |
1327 | */ | |
1328 | struct ieee80211_cipher_scheme { | |
1329 | u32 cipher; | |
1330 | u16 iftype; | |
1331 | u8 hdr_len; | |
1332 | u8 pn_len; | |
1333 | u8 pn_off; | |
1334 | u8 key_idx_off; | |
1335 | u8 key_idx_mask; | |
1336 | u8 key_idx_shift; | |
1337 | u8 mic_len; | |
1338 | }; | |
1339 | ||
7ac1bd6a JB |
1340 | /** |
1341 | * enum set_key_cmd - key command | |
1342 | * | |
1343 | * Used with the set_key() callback in &struct ieee80211_ops, this | |
1344 | * indicates whether a key is being removed or added. | |
1345 | * | |
1346 | * @SET_KEY: a key is set | |
1347 | * @DISABLE_KEY: a key must be disabled | |
1348 | */ | |
ea49c359 | 1349 | enum set_key_cmd { |
11a843b7 | 1350 | SET_KEY, DISABLE_KEY, |
ea49c359 | 1351 | }; |
f0706e82 | 1352 | |
f09603a2 JB |
1353 | /** |
1354 | * enum ieee80211_sta_state - station state | |
1355 | * | |
1356 | * @IEEE80211_STA_NOTEXIST: station doesn't exist at all, | |
1357 | * this is a special state for add/remove transitions | |
1358 | * @IEEE80211_STA_NONE: station exists without special state | |
1359 | * @IEEE80211_STA_AUTH: station is authenticated | |
1360 | * @IEEE80211_STA_ASSOC: station is associated | |
1361 | * @IEEE80211_STA_AUTHORIZED: station is authorized (802.1X) | |
1362 | */ | |
1363 | enum ieee80211_sta_state { | |
1364 | /* NOTE: These need to be ordered correctly! */ | |
1365 | IEEE80211_STA_NOTEXIST, | |
1366 | IEEE80211_STA_NONE, | |
1367 | IEEE80211_STA_AUTH, | |
1368 | IEEE80211_STA_ASSOC, | |
1369 | IEEE80211_STA_AUTHORIZED, | |
1370 | }; | |
1371 | ||
e1a0c6b3 JB |
1372 | /** |
1373 | * enum ieee80211_sta_rx_bandwidth - station RX bandwidth | |
1374 | * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_20: station can only receive 20 MHz | |
1375 | * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_40: station can receive up to 40 MHz | |
1376 | * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_80: station can receive up to 80 MHz | |
1377 | * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_160: station can receive up to 160 MHz | |
1378 | * (including 80+80 MHz) | |
1379 | * | |
1380 | * Implementation note: 20 must be zero to be initialized | |
1381 | * correctly, the values must be sorted. | |
1382 | */ | |
1383 | enum ieee80211_sta_rx_bandwidth { | |
1384 | IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_20 = 0, | |
1385 | IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_40, | |
1386 | IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_80, | |
1387 | IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_160, | |
1388 | }; | |
1389 | ||
0d528d85 FF |
1390 | /** |
1391 | * struct ieee80211_sta_rates - station rate selection table | |
1392 | * | |
1393 | * @rcu_head: RCU head used for freeing the table on update | |
03f831a6 | 1394 | * @rate: transmit rates/flags to be used by default. |
0d528d85 FF |
1395 | * Overriding entries per-packet is possible by using cb tx control. |
1396 | */ | |
1397 | struct ieee80211_sta_rates { | |
1398 | struct rcu_head rcu_head; | |
1399 | struct { | |
1400 | s8 idx; | |
1401 | u8 count; | |
1402 | u8 count_cts; | |
1403 | u8 count_rts; | |
1404 | u16 flags; | |
1405 | } rate[IEEE80211_TX_RATE_TABLE_SIZE]; | |
1406 | }; | |
1407 | ||
17741cdc JB |
1408 | /** |
1409 | * struct ieee80211_sta - station table entry | |
1410 | * | |
1411 | * A station table entry represents a station we are possibly | |
1412 | * communicating with. Since stations are RCU-managed in | |
1413 | * mac80211, any ieee80211_sta pointer you get access to must | |
1414 | * either be protected by rcu_read_lock() explicitly or implicitly, | |
1415 | * or you must take good care to not use such a pointer after a | |
34e89507 | 1416 | * call to your sta_remove callback that removed it. |
17741cdc JB |
1417 | * |
1418 | * @addr: MAC address | |
1419 | * @aid: AID we assigned to the station if we're an AP | |
323ce79a | 1420 | * @supp_rates: Bitmap of supported rates (per band) |
55d942f4 JB |
1421 | * @ht_cap: HT capabilities of this STA; restricted to our own capabilities |
1422 | * @vht_cap: VHT capabilities of this STA; restricted to our own capabilities | |
39df600a | 1423 | * @wme: indicates whether the STA supports WME. Only valid during AP-mode. |
17741cdc JB |
1424 | * @drv_priv: data area for driver use, will always be aligned to |
1425 | * sizeof(void *), size is determined in hw information. | |
910868db EP |
1426 | * @uapsd_queues: bitmap of queues configured for uapsd. Only valid |
1427 | * if wme is supported. | |
1428 | * @max_sp: max Service Period. Only valid if wme is supported. | |
e1a0c6b3 | 1429 | * @bandwidth: current bandwidth the station can receive with |
8921d04e JB |
1430 | * @rx_nss: in HT/VHT, the maximum number of spatial streams the |
1431 | * station can receive at the moment, changed by operating mode | |
1432 | * notifications and capabilities. The value is only valid after | |
1433 | * the station moves to associated state. | |
af0ed69b | 1434 | * @smps_mode: current SMPS mode (off, static or dynamic) |
03f831a6 | 1435 | * @rates: rate control selection table |
0c4972cc | 1436 | * @tdls: indicates whether the STA is a TDLS peer |
17741cdc JB |
1437 | */ |
1438 | struct ieee80211_sta { | |
881d948c | 1439 | u32 supp_rates[IEEE80211_NUM_BANDS]; |
17741cdc JB |
1440 | u8 addr[ETH_ALEN]; |
1441 | u16 aid; | |
d9fe60de | 1442 | struct ieee80211_sta_ht_cap ht_cap; |
818255ea | 1443 | struct ieee80211_sta_vht_cap vht_cap; |
39df600a | 1444 | bool wme; |
9533b4ac EP |
1445 | u8 uapsd_queues; |
1446 | u8 max_sp; | |
8921d04e | 1447 | u8 rx_nss; |
e1a0c6b3 | 1448 | enum ieee80211_sta_rx_bandwidth bandwidth; |
af0ed69b | 1449 | enum ieee80211_smps_mode smps_mode; |
0d528d85 | 1450 | struct ieee80211_sta_rates __rcu *rates; |
0c4972cc | 1451 | bool tdls; |
17741cdc JB |
1452 | |
1453 | /* must be last */ | |
1c06ef98 | 1454 | u8 drv_priv[0] __aligned(sizeof(void *)); |
17741cdc JB |
1455 | }; |
1456 | ||
478f8d2b TW |
1457 | /** |
1458 | * enum sta_notify_cmd - sta notify command | |
1459 | * | |
1460 | * Used with the sta_notify() callback in &struct ieee80211_ops, this | |
38a6cc75 | 1461 | * indicates if an associated station made a power state transition. |
478f8d2b | 1462 | * |
4571d3bf CL |
1463 | * @STA_NOTIFY_SLEEP: a station is now sleeping |
1464 | * @STA_NOTIFY_AWAKE: a sleeping station woke up | |
1465 | */ | |
89fad578 | 1466 | enum sta_notify_cmd { |
4571d3bf CL |
1467 | STA_NOTIFY_SLEEP, STA_NOTIFY_AWAKE, |
1468 | }; | |
1469 | ||
36323f81 TH |
1470 | /** |
1471 | * struct ieee80211_tx_control - TX control data | |
1472 | * | |
1473 | * @sta: station table entry, this sta pointer may be NULL and | |
1474 | * it is not allowed to copy the pointer, due to RCU. | |
1475 | */ | |
1476 | struct ieee80211_tx_control { | |
1477 | struct ieee80211_sta *sta; | |
1478 | }; | |
1479 | ||
1bc0826c JB |
1480 | /** |
1481 | * enum ieee80211_hw_flags - hardware flags | |
1482 | * | |
1483 | * These flags are used to indicate hardware capabilities to | |
1484 | * the stack. Generally, flags here should have their meaning | |
1485 | * done in a way that the simplest hardware doesn't need setting | |
1486 | * any particular flags. There are some exceptions to this rule, | |
1487 | * however, so you are advised to review these flags carefully. | |
1488 | * | |
af65cd96 JB |
1489 | * @IEEE80211_HW_HAS_RATE_CONTROL: |
1490 | * The hardware or firmware includes rate control, and cannot be | |
1491 | * controlled by the stack. As such, no rate control algorithm | |
1492 | * should be instantiated, and the TX rate reported to userspace | |
1493 | * will be taken from the TX status instead of the rate control | |
1494 | * algorithm. | |
1495 | * Note that this requires that the driver implement a number of | |
1496 | * callbacks so it has the correct information, it needs to have | |
1497 | * the @set_rts_threshold callback and must look at the BSS config | |
1498 | * @use_cts_prot for G/N protection, @use_short_slot for slot | |
1499 | * timing in 2.4 GHz and @use_short_preamble for preambles for | |
1500 | * CCK frames. | |
1501 | * | |
1bc0826c JB |
1502 | * @IEEE80211_HW_RX_INCLUDES_FCS: |
1503 | * Indicates that received frames passed to the stack include | |
1504 | * the FCS at the end. | |
1505 | * | |
1506 | * @IEEE80211_HW_HOST_BROADCAST_PS_BUFFERING: | |
1507 | * Some wireless LAN chipsets buffer broadcast/multicast frames | |
1508 | * for power saving stations in the hardware/firmware and others | |
1509 | * rely on the host system for such buffering. This option is used | |
1510 | * to configure the IEEE 802.11 upper layer to buffer broadcast and | |
1511 | * multicast frames when there are power saving stations so that | |
546c80c9 | 1512 | * the driver can fetch them with ieee80211_get_buffered_bc(). |
1bc0826c | 1513 | * |
8318d78a JB |
1514 | * @IEEE80211_HW_2GHZ_SHORT_SLOT_INCAPABLE: |
1515 | * Hardware is not capable of short slot operation on the 2.4 GHz band. | |
1516 | * | |
1517 | * @IEEE80211_HW_2GHZ_SHORT_PREAMBLE_INCAPABLE: | |
1518 | * Hardware is not capable of receiving frames with short preamble on | |
1519 | * the 2.4 GHz band. | |
566bfe5a BR |
1520 | * |
1521 | * @IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_UNSPEC: | |
1522 | * Hardware can provide signal values but we don't know its units. We | |
1523 | * expect values between 0 and @max_signal. | |
1524 | * If possible please provide dB or dBm instead. | |
1525 | * | |
566bfe5a BR |
1526 | * @IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_DBM: |
1527 | * Hardware gives signal values in dBm, decibel difference from | |
1528 | * one milliwatt. This is the preferred method since it is standardized | |
1529 | * between different devices. @max_signal does not need to be set. | |
1530 | * | |
06ff47bc TW |
1531 | * @IEEE80211_HW_SPECTRUM_MGMT: |
1532 | * Hardware supports spectrum management defined in 802.11h | |
1533 | * Measurement, Channel Switch, Quieting, TPC | |
8b30b1fe S |
1534 | * |
1535 | * @IEEE80211_HW_AMPDU_AGGREGATION: | |
1536 | * Hardware supports 11n A-MPDU aggregation. | |
520eb820 | 1537 | * |
4be8c387 JB |
1538 | * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS: |
1539 | * Hardware has power save support (i.e. can go to sleep). | |
1540 | * | |
1541 | * @IEEE80211_HW_PS_NULLFUNC_STACK: | |
1542 | * Hardware requires nullfunc frame handling in stack, implies | |
1543 | * stack support for dynamic PS. | |
1544 | * | |
1545 | * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_DYNAMIC_PS: | |
1546 | * Hardware has support for dynamic PS. | |
4375d083 JM |
1547 | * |
1548 | * @IEEE80211_HW_MFP_CAPABLE: | |
1549 | * Hardware supports management frame protection (MFP, IEEE 802.11w). | |
04de8381 | 1550 | * |
0f78231b JB |
1551 | * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_STATIC_SMPS: |
1552 | * Hardware supports static spatial multiplexing powersave, | |
1553 | * ie. can turn off all but one chain even on HT connections | |
1554 | * that should be using more chains. | |
1555 | * | |
1556 | * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_DYNAMIC_SMPS: | |
1557 | * Hardware supports dynamic spatial multiplexing powersave, | |
1558 | * ie. can turn off all but one chain and then wake the rest | |
1559 | * up as required after, for example, rts/cts handshake. | |
ab13315a KV |
1560 | * |
1561 | * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_UAPSD: | |
1562 | * Hardware supports Unscheduled Automatic Power Save Delivery | |
1563 | * (U-APSD) in managed mode. The mode is configured with | |
1564 | * conf_tx() operation. | |
375177bf VN |
1565 | * |
1566 | * @IEEE80211_HW_REPORTS_TX_ACK_STATUS: | |
1567 | * Hardware can provide ack status reports of Tx frames to | |
1568 | * the stack. | |
1569 | * | |
1e4dcd01 | 1570 | * @IEEE80211_HW_CONNECTION_MONITOR: |
ad24b0da JB |
1571 | * The hardware performs its own connection monitoring, including |
1572 | * periodic keep-alives to the AP and probing the AP on beacon loss. | |
a97c13c3 | 1573 | * |
c65dd147 EG |
1574 | * @IEEE80211_HW_NEED_DTIM_BEFORE_ASSOC: |
1575 | * This device needs to get data from beacon before association (i.e. | |
1576 | * dtim_period). | |
e31b8213 JB |
1577 | * |
1578 | * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PER_STA_GTK: The device's crypto engine supports | |
1579 | * per-station GTKs as used by IBSS RSN or during fast transition. If | |
1580 | * the device doesn't support per-station GTKs, but can be asked not | |
1581 | * to decrypt group addressed frames, then IBSS RSN support is still | |
1582 | * possible but software crypto will be used. Advertise the wiphy flag | |
1583 | * only in that case. | |
d057e5a3 AN |
1584 | * |
1585 | * @IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS: When operating in AP mode the device | |
1586 | * autonomously manages the PS status of connected stations. When | |
1587 | * this flag is set mac80211 will not trigger PS mode for connected | |
1588 | * stations based on the PM bit of incoming frames. | |
1589 | * Use ieee80211_start_ps()/ieee8021_end_ps() to manually configure | |
1590 | * the PS mode of connected stations. | |
edf6b784 AN |
1591 | * |
1592 | * @IEEE80211_HW_TX_AMPDU_SETUP_IN_HW: The device handles TX A-MPDU session | |
1593 | * setup strictly in HW. mac80211 should not attempt to do this in | |
1594 | * software. | |
885bd8ec | 1595 | * |
4b6f1dd6 JB |
1596 | * @IEEE80211_HW_WANT_MONITOR_VIF: The driver would like to be informed of |
1597 | * a virtual monitor interface when monitor interfaces are the only | |
1598 | * active interfaces. | |
3a25a8c8 JB |
1599 | * |
1600 | * @IEEE80211_HW_QUEUE_CONTROL: The driver wants to control per-interface | |
1601 | * queue mapping in order to use different queues (not just one per AC) | |
1602 | * for different virtual interfaces. See the doc section on HW queue | |
1603 | * control for more details. | |
6d71117a | 1604 | * |
0d528d85 FF |
1605 | * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_RC_TABLE: The driver supports using a rate |
1606 | * selection table provided by the rate control algorithm. | |
1607 | * | |
6d71117a JB |
1608 | * @IEEE80211_HW_P2P_DEV_ADDR_FOR_INTF: Use the P2P Device address for any |
1609 | * P2P Interface. This will be honoured even if more than one interface | |
1610 | * is supported. | |
ef429dad JB |
1611 | * |
1612 | * @IEEE80211_HW_TIMING_BEACON_ONLY: Use sync timing from beacon frames | |
1613 | * only, to allow getting TBTT of a DTIM beacon. | |
7578d575 | 1614 | * |
919be62b JB |
1615 | * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_HT_CCK_RATES: Hardware supports mixing HT/CCK rates |
1616 | * and can cope with CCK rates in an aggregation session (e.g. by not | |
1617 | * using aggregation for such frames.) | |
1618 | * | |
7578d575 AN |
1619 | * @IEEE80211_HW_CHANCTX_STA_CSA: Support 802.11h based channel-switch (CSA) |
1620 | * for a single active channel while using channel contexts. When support | |
1621 | * is not enabled the default action is to disconnect when getting the | |
1622 | * CSA frame. | |
5d52ee81 LC |
1623 | * |
1624 | * @IEEE80211_HW_CHANGE_RUNNING_CHANCTX: The hardware can change a | |
1625 | * channel context on-the-fly. This is needed for channel switch | |
1626 | * on single-channel hardware. It can also be used as an | |
1627 | * optimization in certain channel switch cases with | |
1628 | * multi-channel. | |
c56ef672 DS |
1629 | * |
1630 | * @IEEE80211_SINGLE_HW_SCAN_ON_ALL_BANDS: The HW supports scanning on all bands | |
1631 | * in one command, mac80211 doesn't have to run separate scans per band. | |
1bc0826c JB |
1632 | */ |
1633 | enum ieee80211_hw_flags { | |
af65cd96 | 1634 | IEEE80211_HW_HAS_RATE_CONTROL = 1<<0, |
1bc0826c JB |
1635 | IEEE80211_HW_RX_INCLUDES_FCS = 1<<1, |
1636 | IEEE80211_HW_HOST_BROADCAST_PS_BUFFERING = 1<<2, | |
8318d78a JB |
1637 | IEEE80211_HW_2GHZ_SHORT_SLOT_INCAPABLE = 1<<3, |
1638 | IEEE80211_HW_2GHZ_SHORT_PREAMBLE_INCAPABLE = 1<<4, | |
566bfe5a | 1639 | IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_UNSPEC = 1<<5, |
7fee5372 | 1640 | IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_DBM = 1<<6, |
c65dd147 | 1641 | IEEE80211_HW_NEED_DTIM_BEFORE_ASSOC = 1<<7, |
7fee5372 JB |
1642 | IEEE80211_HW_SPECTRUM_MGMT = 1<<8, |
1643 | IEEE80211_HW_AMPDU_AGGREGATION = 1<<9, | |
1644 | IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS = 1<<10, | |
1645 | IEEE80211_HW_PS_NULLFUNC_STACK = 1<<11, | |
1646 | IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_DYNAMIC_PS = 1<<12, | |
1647 | IEEE80211_HW_MFP_CAPABLE = 1<<13, | |
4b6f1dd6 | 1648 | IEEE80211_HW_WANT_MONITOR_VIF = 1<<14, |
0f78231b JB |
1649 | IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_STATIC_SMPS = 1<<15, |
1650 | IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_DYNAMIC_SMPS = 1<<16, | |
ab13315a | 1651 | IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_UAPSD = 1<<17, |
375177bf | 1652 | IEEE80211_HW_REPORTS_TX_ACK_STATUS = 1<<18, |
1e4dcd01 | 1653 | IEEE80211_HW_CONNECTION_MONITOR = 1<<19, |
3a25a8c8 | 1654 | IEEE80211_HW_QUEUE_CONTROL = 1<<20, |
e31b8213 | 1655 | IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PER_STA_GTK = 1<<21, |
d057e5a3 | 1656 | IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS = 1<<22, |
edf6b784 | 1657 | IEEE80211_HW_TX_AMPDU_SETUP_IN_HW = 1<<23, |
0d528d85 | 1658 | IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_RC_TABLE = 1<<24, |
6d71117a | 1659 | IEEE80211_HW_P2P_DEV_ADDR_FOR_INTF = 1<<25, |
ef429dad | 1660 | IEEE80211_HW_TIMING_BEACON_ONLY = 1<<26, |
2dfca312 | 1661 | IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_HT_CCK_RATES = 1<<27, |
7578d575 | 1662 | IEEE80211_HW_CHANCTX_STA_CSA = 1<<28, |
5d52ee81 | 1663 | IEEE80211_HW_CHANGE_RUNNING_CHANCTX = 1<<29, |
c56ef672 | 1664 | IEEE80211_SINGLE_HW_SCAN_ON_ALL_BANDS = 1<<30, |
1bc0826c JB |
1665 | }; |
1666 | ||
7ac1bd6a JB |
1667 | /** |
1668 | * struct ieee80211_hw - hardware information and state | |
75a5f0cc JB |
1669 | * |
1670 | * This structure contains the configuration and hardware | |
1671 | * information for an 802.11 PHY. | |
1672 | * | |
1673 | * @wiphy: This points to the &struct wiphy allocated for this | |
1674 | * 802.11 PHY. You must fill in the @perm_addr and @dev | |
1675 | * members of this structure using SET_IEEE80211_DEV() | |
8318d78a JB |
1676 | * and SET_IEEE80211_PERM_ADDR(). Additionally, all supported |
1677 | * bands (with channels, bitrates) are registered here. | |
75a5f0cc JB |
1678 | * |
1679 | * @conf: &struct ieee80211_conf, device configuration, don't use. | |
1680 | * | |
75a5f0cc JB |
1681 | * @priv: pointer to private area that was allocated for driver use |
1682 | * along with this structure. | |
1683 | * | |
1684 | * @flags: hardware flags, see &enum ieee80211_hw_flags. | |
1685 | * | |
1686 | * @extra_tx_headroom: headroom to reserve in each transmit skb | |
1687 | * for use by the driver (e.g. for transmit headers.) | |
1688 | * | |
70dabeb7 FF |
1689 | * @extra_beacon_tailroom: tailroom to reserve in each beacon tx skb. |
1690 | * Can be used by drivers to add extra IEs. | |
75a5f0cc | 1691 | * |
566bfe5a | 1692 | * @max_signal: Maximum value for signal (rssi) in RX information, used |
ad24b0da | 1693 | * only when @IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_UNSPEC or @IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_DB |
75a5f0cc | 1694 | * |
ea95bba4 | 1695 | * @max_listen_interval: max listen interval in units of beacon interval |
ad24b0da | 1696 | * that HW supports |
ea95bba4 | 1697 | * |
75a5f0cc | 1698 | * @queues: number of available hardware transmit queues for |
e100bb64 JB |
1699 | * data packets. WMM/QoS requires at least four, these |
1700 | * queues need to have configurable access parameters. | |
1701 | * | |
830f9038 JB |
1702 | * @rate_control_algorithm: rate control algorithm for this hardware. |
1703 | * If unset (NULL), the default algorithm will be used. Must be | |
1704 | * set before calling ieee80211_register_hw(). | |
32bfd35d JB |
1705 | * |
1706 | * @vif_data_size: size (in bytes) of the drv_priv data area | |
1707 | * within &struct ieee80211_vif. | |
17741cdc JB |
1708 | * @sta_data_size: size (in bytes) of the drv_priv data area |
1709 | * within &struct ieee80211_sta. | |
d01a1e65 MK |
1710 | * @chanctx_data_size: size (in bytes) of the drv_priv data area |
1711 | * within &struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf. | |
870abdf6 | 1712 | * |
78be49ec HS |
1713 | * @max_rates: maximum number of alternate rate retry stages the hw |
1714 | * can handle. | |
1715 | * @max_report_rates: maximum number of alternate rate retry stages | |
1716 | * the hw can report back. | |
e6a9854b | 1717 | * @max_rate_tries: maximum number of tries for each stage |
4e6cbfd0 | 1718 | * |
df6ba5d8 LC |
1719 | * @max_rx_aggregation_subframes: maximum buffer size (number of |
1720 | * sub-frames) to be used for A-MPDU block ack receiver | |
1721 | * aggregation. | |
1722 | * This is only relevant if the device has restrictions on the | |
1723 | * number of subframes, if it relies on mac80211 to do reordering | |
1724 | * it shouldn't be set. | |
5dd36bc9 JB |
1725 | * |
1726 | * @max_tx_aggregation_subframes: maximum number of subframes in an | |
1727 | * aggregate an HT driver will transmit, used by the peer as a | |
1728 | * hint to size its reorder buffer. | |
3a25a8c8 JB |
1729 | * |
1730 | * @offchannel_tx_hw_queue: HW queue ID to use for offchannel TX | |
1731 | * (if %IEEE80211_HW_QUEUE_CONTROL is set) | |
ac55d2fe JB |
1732 | * |
1733 | * @radiotap_mcs_details: lists which MCS information can the HW | |
1734 | * reports, by default it is set to _MCS, _GI and _BW but doesn't | |
1735 | * include _FMT. Use %IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_MCS_HAVE_* values, only | |
1736 | * adding _BW is supported today. | |
72d78728 | 1737 | * |
51648921 JB |
1738 | * @radiotap_vht_details: lists which VHT MCS information the HW reports, |
1739 | * the default is _GI | _BANDWIDTH. | |
1740 | * Use the %IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_VHT_KNOWN_* values. | |
1741 | * | |
72d78728 AN |
1742 | * @netdev_features: netdev features to be set in each netdev created |
1743 | * from this HW. Note only HW checksum features are currently | |
1744 | * compatible with mac80211. Other feature bits will be rejected. | |
219c3867 AB |
1745 | * |
1746 | * @uapsd_queues: This bitmap is included in (re)association frame to indicate | |
1747 | * for each access category if it is uAPSD trigger-enabled and delivery- | |
1748 | * enabled. Use IEEE80211_WMM_IE_STA_QOSINFO_AC_* to set this bitmap. | |
1749 | * Each bit corresponds to different AC. Value '1' in specific bit means | |
1750 | * that corresponding AC is both trigger- and delivery-enabled. '0' means | |
1751 | * neither enabled. | |
1752 | * | |
1753 | * @uapsd_max_sp_len: maximum number of total buffered frames the WMM AP may | |
1754 | * deliver to a WMM STA during any Service Period triggered by the WMM STA. | |
1755 | * Use IEEE80211_WMM_IE_STA_QOSINFO_SP_* for correct values. | |
2475b1cc MS |
1756 | * |
1757 | * @n_cipher_schemes: a size of an array of cipher schemes definitions. | |
1758 | * @cipher_schemes: a pointer to an array of cipher scheme definitions | |
1759 | * supported by HW. | |
7ac1bd6a | 1760 | */ |
f0706e82 | 1761 | struct ieee80211_hw { |
f0706e82 | 1762 | struct ieee80211_conf conf; |
75a5f0cc | 1763 | struct wiphy *wiphy; |
830f9038 | 1764 | const char *rate_control_algorithm; |
f0706e82 | 1765 | void *priv; |
75a5f0cc | 1766 | u32 flags; |
f0706e82 | 1767 | unsigned int extra_tx_headroom; |
70dabeb7 | 1768 | unsigned int extra_beacon_tailroom; |
32bfd35d | 1769 | int vif_data_size; |
17741cdc | 1770 | int sta_data_size; |
d01a1e65 | 1771 | int chanctx_data_size; |
ea95bba4 | 1772 | u16 queues; |
ea95bba4 | 1773 | u16 max_listen_interval; |
f0706e82 | 1774 | s8 max_signal; |
e6a9854b | 1775 | u8 max_rates; |
78be49ec | 1776 | u8 max_report_rates; |
e6a9854b | 1777 | u8 max_rate_tries; |
df6ba5d8 | 1778 | u8 max_rx_aggregation_subframes; |
5dd36bc9 | 1779 | u8 max_tx_aggregation_subframes; |
3a25a8c8 | 1780 | u8 offchannel_tx_hw_queue; |
ac55d2fe | 1781 | u8 radiotap_mcs_details; |
51648921 | 1782 | u16 radiotap_vht_details; |
72d78728 | 1783 | netdev_features_t netdev_features; |
219c3867 AB |
1784 | u8 uapsd_queues; |
1785 | u8 uapsd_max_sp_len; | |
2475b1cc MS |
1786 | u8 n_cipher_schemes; |
1787 | const struct ieee80211_cipher_scheme *cipher_schemes; | |
f0706e82 JB |
1788 | }; |
1789 | ||
c56ef672 DS |
1790 | /** |
1791 | * struct ieee80211_scan_request - hw scan request | |
1792 | * | |
1793 | * @ies: pointers different parts of IEs (in req.ie) | |
1794 | * @req: cfg80211 request. | |
1795 | */ | |
1796 | struct ieee80211_scan_request { | |
1797 | struct ieee80211_scan_ies ies; | |
1798 | ||
1799 | /* Keep last */ | |
1800 | struct cfg80211_scan_request req; | |
1801 | }; | |
1802 | ||
9a95371a LR |
1803 | /** |
1804 | * wiphy_to_ieee80211_hw - return a mac80211 driver hw struct from a wiphy | |
1805 | * | |
1806 | * @wiphy: the &struct wiphy which we want to query | |
1807 | * | |
1808 | * mac80211 drivers can use this to get to their respective | |
1809 | * &struct ieee80211_hw. Drivers wishing to get to their own private | |
1810 | * structure can then access it via hw->priv. Note that mac802111 drivers should | |
1811 | * not use wiphy_priv() to try to get their private driver structure as this | |
1812 | * is already used internally by mac80211. | |
0ae997dc YB |
1813 | * |
1814 | * Return: The mac80211 driver hw struct of @wiphy. | |
9a95371a LR |
1815 | */ |
1816 | struct ieee80211_hw *wiphy_to_ieee80211_hw(struct wiphy *wiphy); | |
1817 | ||
75a5f0cc JB |
1818 | /** |
1819 | * SET_IEEE80211_DEV - set device for 802.11 hardware | |
1820 | * | |
1821 | * @hw: the &struct ieee80211_hw to set the device for | |
1822 | * @dev: the &struct device of this 802.11 device | |
1823 | */ | |
f0706e82 JB |
1824 | static inline void SET_IEEE80211_DEV(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct device *dev) |
1825 | { | |
1826 | set_wiphy_dev(hw->wiphy, dev); | |
1827 | } | |
1828 | ||
75a5f0cc | 1829 | /** |
e37d4dff | 1830 | * SET_IEEE80211_PERM_ADDR - set the permanent MAC address for 802.11 hardware |
75a5f0cc JB |
1831 | * |
1832 | * @hw: the &struct ieee80211_hw to set the MAC address for | |
1833 | * @addr: the address to set | |
1834 | */ | |
f0706e82 JB |
1835 | static inline void SET_IEEE80211_PERM_ADDR(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u8 *addr) |
1836 | { | |
1837 | memcpy(hw->wiphy->perm_addr, addr, ETH_ALEN); | |
1838 | } | |
1839 | ||
2e92e6f2 JB |
1840 | static inline struct ieee80211_rate * |
1841 | ieee80211_get_tx_rate(const struct ieee80211_hw *hw, | |
e039fa4a | 1842 | const struct ieee80211_tx_info *c) |
2e92e6f2 | 1843 | { |
aa331df0 | 1844 | if (WARN_ON_ONCE(c->control.rates[0].idx < 0)) |
2e92e6f2 | 1845 | return NULL; |
e6a9854b | 1846 | return &hw->wiphy->bands[c->band]->bitrates[c->control.rates[0].idx]; |
2e92e6f2 JB |
1847 | } |
1848 | ||
1849 | static inline struct ieee80211_rate * | |
1850 | ieee80211_get_rts_cts_rate(const struct ieee80211_hw *hw, | |
e039fa4a | 1851 | const struct ieee80211_tx_info *c) |
2e92e6f2 | 1852 | { |
e039fa4a | 1853 | if (c->control.rts_cts_rate_idx < 0) |
2e92e6f2 | 1854 | return NULL; |
e039fa4a | 1855 | return &hw->wiphy->bands[c->band]->bitrates[c->control.rts_cts_rate_idx]; |
2e92e6f2 JB |
1856 | } |
1857 | ||
1858 | static inline struct ieee80211_rate * | |
1859 | ieee80211_get_alt_retry_rate(const struct ieee80211_hw *hw, | |
870abdf6 | 1860 | const struct ieee80211_tx_info *c, int idx) |
2e92e6f2 | 1861 | { |
e6a9854b | 1862 | if (c->control.rates[idx + 1].idx < 0) |
2e92e6f2 | 1863 | return NULL; |
e6a9854b | 1864 | return &hw->wiphy->bands[c->band]->bitrates[c->control.rates[idx + 1].idx]; |
2e92e6f2 JB |
1865 | } |
1866 | ||
6096de7f JB |
1867 | /** |
1868 | * ieee80211_free_txskb - free TX skb | |
1869 | * @hw: the hardware | |
1870 | * @skb: the skb | |
1871 | * | |
1872 | * Free a transmit skb. Use this funtion when some failure | |
1873 | * to transmit happened and thus status cannot be reported. | |
1874 | */ | |
1875 | void ieee80211_free_txskb(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct sk_buff *skb); | |
1876 | ||
75a5f0cc JB |
1877 | /** |
1878 | * DOC: Hardware crypto acceleration | |
1879 | * | |
1880 | * mac80211 is capable of taking advantage of many hardware | |
1881 | * acceleration designs for encryption and decryption operations. | |
1882 | * | |
1883 | * The set_key() callback in the &struct ieee80211_ops for a given | |
1884 | * device is called to enable hardware acceleration of encryption and | |
dc822b5d JB |
1885 | * decryption. The callback takes a @sta parameter that will be NULL |
1886 | * for default keys or keys used for transmission only, or point to | |
1887 | * the station information for the peer for individual keys. | |
75a5f0cc JB |
1888 | * Multiple transmission keys with the same key index may be used when |
1889 | * VLANs are configured for an access point. | |
4150c572 | 1890 | * |
75a5f0cc JB |
1891 | * When transmitting, the TX control data will use the @hw_key_idx |
1892 | * selected by the driver by modifying the &struct ieee80211_key_conf | |
1893 | * pointed to by the @key parameter to the set_key() function. | |
1894 | * | |
1895 | * The set_key() call for the %SET_KEY command should return 0 if | |
1896 | * the key is now in use, -%EOPNOTSUPP or -%ENOSPC if it couldn't be | |
1897 | * added; if you return 0 then hw_key_idx must be assigned to the | |
1898 | * hardware key index, you are free to use the full u8 range. | |
1899 | * | |
1900 | * When the cmd is %DISABLE_KEY then it must succeed. | |
1901 | * | |
1902 | * Note that it is permissible to not decrypt a frame even if a key | |
1903 | * for it has been uploaded to hardware, the stack will not make any | |
1904 | * decision based on whether a key has been uploaded or not but rather | |
1905 | * based on the receive flags. | |
1906 | * | |
1907 | * The &struct ieee80211_key_conf structure pointed to by the @key | |
1908 | * parameter is guaranteed to be valid until another call to set_key() | |
1909 | * removes it, but it can only be used as a cookie to differentiate | |
1910 | * keys. | |
9ae4fda3 EG |
1911 | * |
1912 | * In TKIP some HW need to be provided a phase 1 key, for RX decryption | |
1913 | * acceleration (i.e. iwlwifi). Those drivers should provide update_tkip_key | |
1914 | * handler. | |
1915 | * The update_tkip_key() call updates the driver with the new phase 1 key. | |
25985edc | 1916 | * This happens every time the iv16 wraps around (every 65536 packets). The |
9ae4fda3 EG |
1917 | * set_key() call will happen only once for each key (unless the AP did |
1918 | * rekeying), it will not include a valid phase 1 key. The valid phase 1 key is | |
e37d4dff | 1919 | * provided by update_tkip_key only. The trigger that makes mac80211 call this |
9ae4fda3 | 1920 | * handler is software decryption with wrap around of iv16. |
de5fad81 YD |
1921 | * |
1922 | * The set_default_unicast_key() call updates the default WEP key index | |
1923 | * configured to the hardware for WEP encryption type. This is required | |
1924 | * for devices that support offload of data packets (e.g. ARP responses). | |
4150c572 | 1925 | */ |
75a5f0cc | 1926 | |
4be8c387 JB |
1927 | /** |
1928 | * DOC: Powersave support | |
1929 | * | |
1930 | * mac80211 has support for various powersave implementations. | |
1931 | * | |
c99445b1 KV |
1932 | * First, it can support hardware that handles all powersaving by itself, |
1933 | * such hardware should simply set the %IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS hardware | |
1934 | * flag. In that case, it will be told about the desired powersave mode | |
1935 | * with the %IEEE80211_CONF_PS flag depending on the association status. | |
1936 | * The hardware must take care of sending nullfunc frames when necessary, | |
1937 | * i.e. when entering and leaving powersave mode. The hardware is required | |
1938 | * to look at the AID in beacons and signal to the AP that it woke up when | |
1939 | * it finds traffic directed to it. | |
1940 | * | |
1941 | * %IEEE80211_CONF_PS flag enabled means that the powersave mode defined in | |
1942 | * IEEE 802.11-2007 section 11.2 is enabled. This is not to be confused | |
1943 | * with hardware wakeup and sleep states. Driver is responsible for waking | |
2738bd68 BC |
1944 | * up the hardware before issuing commands to the hardware and putting it |
1945 | * back to sleep at appropriate times. | |
c99445b1 KV |
1946 | * |
1947 | * When PS is enabled, hardware needs to wakeup for beacons and receive the | |
1948 | * buffered multicast/broadcast frames after the beacon. Also it must be | |
1949 | * possible to send frames and receive the acknowledment frame. | |
4be8c387 JB |
1950 | * |
1951 | * Other hardware designs cannot send nullfunc frames by themselves and also | |
1952 | * need software support for parsing the TIM bitmap. This is also supported | |
1953 | * by mac80211 by combining the %IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS and | |
1954 | * %IEEE80211_HW_PS_NULLFUNC_STACK flags. The hardware is of course still | |
955394c9 JB |
1955 | * required to pass up beacons. The hardware is still required to handle |
1956 | * waking up for multicast traffic; if it cannot the driver must handle that | |
c99445b1 KV |
1957 | * as best as it can, mac80211 is too slow to do that. |
1958 | * | |
1959 | * Dynamic powersave is an extension to normal powersave in which the | |
1960 | * hardware stays awake for a user-specified period of time after sending a | |
1961 | * frame so that reply frames need not be buffered and therefore delayed to | |
1962 | * the next wakeup. It's compromise of getting good enough latency when | |
1963 | * there's data traffic and still saving significantly power in idle | |
1964 | * periods. | |
1965 | * | |
2738bd68 | 1966 | * Dynamic powersave is simply supported by mac80211 enabling and disabling |
c99445b1 KV |
1967 | * PS based on traffic. Driver needs to only set %IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS |
1968 | * flag and mac80211 will handle everything automatically. Additionally, | |
1969 | * hardware having support for the dynamic PS feature may set the | |
1970 | * %IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_DYNAMIC_PS flag to indicate that it can support | |
1971 | * dynamic PS mode itself. The driver needs to look at the | |
1972 | * @dynamic_ps_timeout hardware configuration value and use it that value | |
1973 | * whenever %IEEE80211_CONF_PS is set. In this case mac80211 will disable | |
1974 | * dynamic PS feature in stack and will just keep %IEEE80211_CONF_PS | |
1975 | * enabled whenever user has enabled powersave. | |
1976 | * | |
1977 | * Driver informs U-APSD client support by enabling | |
1978 | * %IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_UAPSD flag. The mode is configured through the | |
e227867f | 1979 | * uapsd parameter in conf_tx() operation. Hardware needs to send the QoS |
c99445b1 KV |
1980 | * Nullfunc frames and stay awake until the service period has ended. To |
1981 | * utilize U-APSD, dynamic powersave is disabled for voip AC and all frames | |
1982 | * from that AC are transmitted with powersave enabled. | |
1983 | * | |
1984 | * Note: U-APSD client mode is not yet supported with | |
1985 | * %IEEE80211_HW_PS_NULLFUNC_STACK. | |
4be8c387 JB |
1986 | */ |
1987 | ||
04de8381 KV |
1988 | /** |
1989 | * DOC: Beacon filter support | |
1990 | * | |
1991 | * Some hardware have beacon filter support to reduce host cpu wakeups | |
42b2aa86 | 1992 | * which will reduce system power consumption. It usually works so that |
04de8381 KV |
1993 | * the firmware creates a checksum of the beacon but omits all constantly |
1994 | * changing elements (TSF, TIM etc). Whenever the checksum changes the | |
1995 | * beacon is forwarded to the host, otherwise it will be just dropped. That | |
1996 | * way the host will only receive beacons where some relevant information | |
1997 | * (for example ERP protection or WMM settings) have changed. | |
1998 | * | |
c1288b12 JB |
1999 | * Beacon filter support is advertised with the %IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER |
2000 | * interface capability. The driver needs to enable beacon filter support | |
955394c9 JB |
2001 | * whenever power save is enabled, that is %IEEE80211_CONF_PS is set. When |
2002 | * power save is enabled, the stack will not check for beacon loss and the | |
2003 | * driver needs to notify about loss of beacons with ieee80211_beacon_loss(). | |
2004 | * | |
2005 | * The time (or number of beacons missed) until the firmware notifies the | |
2006 | * driver of a beacon loss event (which in turn causes the driver to call | |
2007 | * ieee80211_beacon_loss()) should be configurable and will be controlled | |
2008 | * by mac80211 and the roaming algorithm in the future. | |
2009 | * | |
2010 | * Since there may be constantly changing information elements that nothing | |
2011 | * in the software stack cares about, we will, in the future, have mac80211 | |
2012 | * tell the driver which information elements are interesting in the sense | |
2013 | * that we want to see changes in them. This will include | |
2014 | * - a list of information element IDs | |
2015 | * - a list of OUIs for the vendor information element | |
2016 | * | |
2017 | * Ideally, the hardware would filter out any beacons without changes in the | |
2018 | * requested elements, but if it cannot support that it may, at the expense | |
2019 | * of some efficiency, filter out only a subset. For example, if the device | |
2020 | * doesn't support checking for OUIs it should pass up all changes in all | |
2021 | * vendor information elements. | |
2022 | * | |
2023 | * Note that change, for the sake of simplification, also includes information | |
2024 | * elements appearing or disappearing from the beacon. | |
2025 | * | |
2026 | * Some hardware supports an "ignore list" instead, just make sure nothing | |
2027 | * that was requested is on the ignore list, and include commonly changing | |
2028 | * information element IDs in the ignore list, for example 11 (BSS load) and | |
2029 | * the various vendor-assigned IEs with unknown contents (128, 129, 133-136, | |
2030 | * 149, 150, 155, 156, 173, 176, 178, 179, 219); for forward compatibility | |
2031 | * it could also include some currently unused IDs. | |
2032 | * | |
2033 | * | |
2034 | * In addition to these capabilities, hardware should support notifying the | |
2035 | * host of changes in the beacon RSSI. This is relevant to implement roaming | |
2036 | * when no traffic is flowing (when traffic is flowing we see the RSSI of | |
2037 | * the received data packets). This can consist in notifying the host when | |
2038 | * the RSSI changes significantly or when it drops below or rises above | |
2039 | * configurable thresholds. In the future these thresholds will also be | |
2040 | * configured by mac80211 (which gets them from userspace) to implement | |
2041 | * them as the roaming algorithm requires. | |
2042 | * | |
2043 | * If the hardware cannot implement this, the driver should ask it to | |
2044 | * periodically pass beacon frames to the host so that software can do the | |
2045 | * signal strength threshold checking. | |
04de8381 KV |
2046 | */ |
2047 | ||
0f78231b JB |
2048 | /** |
2049 | * DOC: Spatial multiplexing power save | |
2050 | * | |
2051 | * SMPS (Spatial multiplexing power save) is a mechanism to conserve | |
2052 | * power in an 802.11n implementation. For details on the mechanism | |
2053 | * and rationale, please refer to 802.11 (as amended by 802.11n-2009) | |
2054 | * "11.2.3 SM power save". | |
2055 | * | |
2056 | * The mac80211 implementation is capable of sending action frames | |
2057 | * to update the AP about the station's SMPS mode, and will instruct | |
2058 | * the driver to enter the specific mode. It will also announce the | |
2059 | * requested SMPS mode during the association handshake. Hardware | |
2060 | * support for this feature is required, and can be indicated by | |
2061 | * hardware flags. | |
2062 | * | |
2063 | * The default mode will be "automatic", which nl80211/cfg80211 | |
2064 | * defines to be dynamic SMPS in (regular) powersave, and SMPS | |
2065 | * turned off otherwise. | |
2066 | * | |
2067 | * To support this feature, the driver must set the appropriate | |
2068 | * hardware support flags, and handle the SMPS flag to the config() | |
2069 | * operation. It will then with this mechanism be instructed to | |
2070 | * enter the requested SMPS mode while associated to an HT AP. | |
2071 | */ | |
2072 | ||
75a5f0cc JB |
2073 | /** |
2074 | * DOC: Frame filtering | |
2075 | * | |
2076 | * mac80211 requires to see many management frames for proper | |
2077 | * operation, and users may want to see many more frames when | |
2078 | * in monitor mode. However, for best CPU usage and power consumption, | |
2079 | * having as few frames as possible percolate through the stack is | |
2080 | * desirable. Hence, the hardware should filter as much as possible. | |
2081 | * | |
2082 | * To achieve this, mac80211 uses filter flags (see below) to tell | |
2083 | * the driver's configure_filter() function which frames should be | |
2084 | * passed to mac80211 and which should be filtered out. | |
2085 | * | |
3ac64bee JB |
2086 | * Before configure_filter() is invoked, the prepare_multicast() |
2087 | * callback is invoked with the parameters @mc_count and @mc_list | |
2088 | * for the combined multicast address list of all virtual interfaces. | |
2089 | * It's use is optional, and it returns a u64 that is passed to | |
2090 | * configure_filter(). Additionally, configure_filter() has the | |
2091 | * arguments @changed_flags telling which flags were changed and | |
2092 | * @total_flags with the new flag states. | |
75a5f0cc JB |
2093 | * |
2094 | * If your device has no multicast address filters your driver will | |
2095 | * need to check both the %FIF_ALLMULTI flag and the @mc_count | |
2096 | * parameter to see whether multicast frames should be accepted | |
2097 | * or dropped. | |
2098 | * | |
d0f5afbe MB |
2099 | * All unsupported flags in @total_flags must be cleared. |
2100 | * Hardware does not support a flag if it is incapable of _passing_ | |
2101 | * the frame to the stack. Otherwise the driver must ignore | |
2102 | * the flag, but not clear it. | |
2103 | * You must _only_ clear the flag (announce no support for the | |
2104 | * flag to mac80211) if you are not able to pass the packet type | |
2105 | * to the stack (so the hardware always filters it). | |
2106 | * So for example, you should clear @FIF_CONTROL, if your hardware | |
2107 | * always filters control frames. If your hardware always passes | |
2108 | * control frames to the kernel and is incapable of filtering them, | |
2109 | * you do _not_ clear the @FIF_CONTROL flag. | |
2110 | * This rule applies to all other FIF flags as well. | |
4150c572 | 2111 | */ |
75a5f0cc | 2112 | |
4b801bc9 JB |
2113 | /** |
2114 | * DOC: AP support for powersaving clients | |
2115 | * | |
2116 | * In order to implement AP and P2P GO modes, mac80211 has support for | |
2117 | * client powersaving, both "legacy" PS (PS-Poll/null data) and uAPSD. | |
2118 | * There currently is no support for sAPSD. | |
2119 | * | |
2120 | * There is one assumption that mac80211 makes, namely that a client | |
2121 | * will not poll with PS-Poll and trigger with uAPSD at the same time. | |
2122 | * Both are supported, and both can be used by the same client, but | |
2123 | * they can't be used concurrently by the same client. This simplifies | |
2124 | * the driver code. | |
2125 | * | |
2126 | * The first thing to keep in mind is that there is a flag for complete | |
2127 | * driver implementation: %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS. If this flag is set, | |
2128 | * mac80211 expects the driver to handle most of the state machine for | |
2129 | * powersaving clients and will ignore the PM bit in incoming frames. | |
2130 | * Drivers then use ieee80211_sta_ps_transition() to inform mac80211 of | |
2131 | * stations' powersave transitions. In this mode, mac80211 also doesn't | |
2132 | * handle PS-Poll/uAPSD. | |
2133 | * | |
2134 | * In the mode without %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS, mac80211 will check the | |
2135 | * PM bit in incoming frames for client powersave transitions. When a | |
2136 | * station goes to sleep, we will stop transmitting to it. There is, | |
2137 | * however, a race condition: a station might go to sleep while there is | |
2138 | * data buffered on hardware queues. If the device has support for this | |
2139 | * it will reject frames, and the driver should give the frames back to | |
2140 | * mac80211 with the %IEEE80211_TX_STAT_TX_FILTERED flag set which will | |
2141 | * cause mac80211 to retry the frame when the station wakes up. The | |
2142 | * driver is also notified of powersave transitions by calling its | |
2143 | * @sta_notify callback. | |
2144 | * | |
2145 | * When the station is asleep, it has three choices: it can wake up, | |
2146 | * it can PS-Poll, or it can possibly start a uAPSD service period. | |
2147 | * Waking up is implemented by simply transmitting all buffered (and | |
2148 | * filtered) frames to the station. This is the easiest case. When | |
2149 | * the station sends a PS-Poll or a uAPSD trigger frame, mac80211 | |
2150 | * will inform the driver of this with the @allow_buffered_frames | |
2151 | * callback; this callback is optional. mac80211 will then transmit | |
02f2f1a9 | 2152 | * the frames as usual and set the %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER |
4b801bc9 JB |
2153 | * on each frame. The last frame in the service period (or the only |
2154 | * response to a PS-Poll) also has %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP set to | |
2155 | * indicate that it ends the service period; as this frame must have | |
2156 | * TX status report it also sets %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_REQ_TX_STATUS. | |
2157 | * When TX status is reported for this frame, the service period is | |
2158 | * marked has having ended and a new one can be started by the peer. | |
2159 | * | |
02f2f1a9 JB |
2160 | * Additionally, non-bufferable MMPDUs can also be transmitted by |
2161 | * mac80211 with the %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER set in them. | |
2162 | * | |
4b801bc9 JB |
2163 | * Another race condition can happen on some devices like iwlwifi |
2164 | * when there are frames queued for the station and it wakes up | |
2165 | * or polls; the frames that are already queued could end up being | |
2166 | * transmitted first instead, causing reordering and/or wrong | |
2167 | * processing of the EOSP. The cause is that allowing frames to be | |
2168 | * transmitted to a certain station is out-of-band communication to | |
2169 | * the device. To allow this problem to be solved, the driver can | |
2170 | * call ieee80211_sta_block_awake() if frames are buffered when it | |
2171 | * is notified that the station went to sleep. When all these frames | |
2172 | * have been filtered (see above), it must call the function again | |
2173 | * to indicate that the station is no longer blocked. | |
2174 | * | |
2175 | * If the driver buffers frames in the driver for aggregation in any | |
2176 | * way, it must use the ieee80211_sta_set_buffered() call when it is | |
2177 | * notified of the station going to sleep to inform mac80211 of any | |
2178 | * TIDs that have frames buffered. Note that when a station wakes up | |
2179 | * this information is reset (hence the requirement to call it when | |
2180 | * informed of the station going to sleep). Then, when a service | |
2181 | * period starts for any reason, @release_buffered_frames is called | |
2182 | * with the number of frames to be released and which TIDs they are | |
2183 | * to come from. In this case, the driver is responsible for setting | |
2184 | * the EOSP (for uAPSD) and MORE_DATA bits in the released frames, | |
e227867f | 2185 | * to help the @more_data parameter is passed to tell the driver if |
4b801bc9 JB |
2186 | * there is more data on other TIDs -- the TIDs to release frames |
2187 | * from are ignored since mac80211 doesn't know how many frames the | |
2188 | * buffers for those TIDs contain. | |
2189 | * | |
2190 | * If the driver also implement GO mode, where absence periods may | |
2191 | * shorten service periods (or abort PS-Poll responses), it must | |
2192 | * filter those response frames except in the case of frames that | |
2193 | * are buffered in the driver -- those must remain buffered to avoid | |
2194 | * reordering. Because it is possible that no frames are released | |
e943789e | 2195 | * in this case, the driver must call ieee80211_sta_eosp() |
4b801bc9 JB |
2196 | * to indicate to mac80211 that the service period ended anyway. |
2197 | * | |
2198 | * Finally, if frames from multiple TIDs are released from mac80211 | |
2199 | * but the driver might reorder them, it must clear & set the flags | |
2200 | * appropriately (only the last frame may have %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP) | |
2201 | * and also take care of the EOSP and MORE_DATA bits in the frame. | |
e943789e | 2202 | * The driver may also use ieee80211_sta_eosp() in this case. |
b77cf4f8 JB |
2203 | * |
2204 | * Note that if the driver ever buffers frames other than QoS-data | |
2205 | * frames, it must take care to never send a non-QoS-data frame as | |
2206 | * the last frame in a service period, adding a QoS-nulldata frame | |
2207 | * after a non-QoS-data frame if needed. | |
4b801bc9 JB |
2208 | */ |
2209 | ||
3a25a8c8 JB |
2210 | /** |
2211 | * DOC: HW queue control | |
2212 | * | |
2213 | * Before HW queue control was introduced, mac80211 only had a single static | |
2214 | * assignment of per-interface AC software queues to hardware queues. This | |
2215 | * was problematic for a few reasons: | |
2216 | * 1) off-channel transmissions might get stuck behind other frames | |
2217 | * 2) multiple virtual interfaces couldn't be handled correctly | |
2218 | * 3) after-DTIM frames could get stuck behind other frames | |
2219 | * | |
2220 | * To solve this, hardware typically uses multiple different queues for all | |
2221 | * the different usages, and this needs to be propagated into mac80211 so it | |
2222 | * won't have the same problem with the software queues. | |
2223 | * | |
2224 | * Therefore, mac80211 now offers the %IEEE80211_HW_QUEUE_CONTROL capability | |
2225 | * flag that tells it that the driver implements its own queue control. To do | |
2226 | * so, the driver will set up the various queues in each &struct ieee80211_vif | |
2227 | * and the offchannel queue in &struct ieee80211_hw. In response, mac80211 will | |
2228 | * use those queue IDs in the hw_queue field of &struct ieee80211_tx_info and | |
2229 | * if necessary will queue the frame on the right software queue that mirrors | |
2230 | * the hardware queue. | |
2231 | * Additionally, the driver has to then use these HW queue IDs for the queue | |
2232 | * management functions (ieee80211_stop_queue() et al.) | |
2233 | * | |
2234 | * The driver is free to set up the queue mappings as needed, multiple virtual | |
2235 | * interfaces may map to the same hardware queues if needed. The setup has to | |
2236 | * happen during add_interface or change_interface callbacks. For example, a | |
2237 | * driver supporting station+station and station+AP modes might decide to have | |
2238 | * 10 hardware queues to handle different scenarios: | |
2239 | * | |
2240 | * 4 AC HW queues for 1st vif: 0, 1, 2, 3 | |
2241 | * 4 AC HW queues for 2nd vif: 4, 5, 6, 7 | |
2242 | * after-DTIM queue for AP: 8 | |
2243 | * off-channel queue: 9 | |
2244 | * | |
2245 | * It would then set up the hardware like this: | |
2246 | * hw.offchannel_tx_hw_queue = 9 | |
2247 | * | |
2248 | * and the first virtual interface that is added as follows: | |
2249 | * vif.hw_queue[IEEE80211_AC_VO] = 0 | |
2250 | * vif.hw_queue[IEEE80211_AC_VI] = 1 | |
2251 | * vif.hw_queue[IEEE80211_AC_BE] = 2 | |
2252 | * vif.hw_queue[IEEE80211_AC_BK] = 3 | |
2253 | * vif.cab_queue = 8 // if AP mode, otherwise %IEEE80211_INVAL_HW_QUEUE | |
2254 | * and the second virtual interface with 4-7. | |
2255 | * | |
2256 | * If queue 6 gets full, for example, mac80211 would only stop the second | |
2257 | * virtual interface's BE queue since virtual interface queues are per AC. | |
2258 | * | |
2259 | * Note that the vif.cab_queue value should be set to %IEEE80211_INVAL_HW_QUEUE | |
2260 | * whenever the queue is not used (i.e. the interface is not in AP mode) if the | |
2261 | * queue could potentially be shared since mac80211 will look at cab_queue when | |
2262 | * a queue is stopped/woken even if the interface is not in AP mode. | |
2263 | */ | |
2264 | ||
75a5f0cc JB |
2265 | /** |
2266 | * enum ieee80211_filter_flags - hardware filter flags | |
2267 | * | |
2268 | * These flags determine what the filter in hardware should be | |
2269 | * programmed to let through and what should not be passed to the | |
2270 | * stack. It is always safe to pass more frames than requested, | |
2271 | * but this has negative impact on power consumption. | |
2272 | * | |
2273 | * @FIF_PROMISC_IN_BSS: promiscuous mode within your BSS, | |
2274 | * think of the BSS as your network segment and then this corresponds | |
2275 | * to the regular ethernet device promiscuous mode. | |
2276 | * | |
2277 | * @FIF_ALLMULTI: pass all multicast frames, this is used if requested | |
2278 | * by the user or if the hardware is not capable of filtering by | |
2279 | * multicast address. | |
2280 | * | |
2281 | * @FIF_FCSFAIL: pass frames with failed FCS (but you need to set the | |
2282 | * %RX_FLAG_FAILED_FCS_CRC for them) | |
2283 | * | |
2284 | * @FIF_PLCPFAIL: pass frames with failed PLCP CRC (but you need to set | |
2285 | * the %RX_FLAG_FAILED_PLCP_CRC for them | |
2286 | * | |
2287 | * @FIF_BCN_PRBRESP_PROMISC: This flag is set during scanning to indicate | |
2288 | * to the hardware that it should not filter beacons or probe responses | |
2289 | * by BSSID. Filtering them can greatly reduce the amount of processing | |
2290 | * mac80211 needs to do and the amount of CPU wakeups, so you should | |
2291 | * honour this flag if possible. | |
2292 | * | |
e3b90ca2 | 2293 | * @FIF_CONTROL: pass control frames (except for PS Poll), if PROMISC_IN_BSS |
7be5086d | 2294 | * is not set then only those addressed to this station. |
75a5f0cc JB |
2295 | * |
2296 | * @FIF_OTHER_BSS: pass frames destined to other BSSes | |
e3b90ca2 | 2297 | * |
7be5086d JB |
2298 | * @FIF_PSPOLL: pass PS Poll frames, if PROMISC_IN_BSS is not set then only |
2299 | * those addressed to this station. | |
2300 | * | |
2301 | * @FIF_PROBE_REQ: pass probe request frames | |
4150c572 | 2302 | */ |
75a5f0cc JB |
2303 | enum ieee80211_filter_flags { |
2304 | FIF_PROMISC_IN_BSS = 1<<0, | |
2305 | FIF_ALLMULTI = 1<<1, | |
2306 | FIF_FCSFAIL = 1<<2, | |
2307 | FIF_PLCPFAIL = 1<<3, | |
2308 | FIF_BCN_PRBRESP_PROMISC = 1<<4, | |
2309 | FIF_CONTROL = 1<<5, | |
2310 | FIF_OTHER_BSS = 1<<6, | |
e3b90ca2 | 2311 | FIF_PSPOLL = 1<<7, |
7be5086d | 2312 | FIF_PROBE_REQ = 1<<8, |
75a5f0cc JB |
2313 | }; |
2314 | ||
1b7d03ac RR |
2315 | /** |
2316 | * enum ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action - A-MPDU actions | |
2317 | * | |
2318 | * These flags are used with the ampdu_action() callback in | |
2319 | * &struct ieee80211_ops to indicate which action is needed. | |
827d42c9 JB |
2320 | * |
2321 | * Note that drivers MUST be able to deal with a TX aggregation | |
2322 | * session being stopped even before they OK'ed starting it by | |
5d22c89b | 2323 | * calling ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe, because the peer |
827d42c9 JB |
2324 | * might receive the addBA frame and send a delBA right away! |
2325 | * | |
18b559d5 JB |
2326 | * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START: start RX aggregation |
2327 | * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_STOP: stop RX aggregation | |
2328 | * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START: start TX aggregation | |
b1720231 | 2329 | * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL: TX aggregation has become operational |
18b559d5 JB |
2330 | * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_CONT: stop TX aggregation but continue transmitting |
2331 | * queued packets, now unaggregated. After all packets are transmitted the | |
2332 | * driver has to call ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe(). | |
2333 | * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_FLUSH: stop TX aggregation and flush all packets, | |
2334 | * called when the station is removed. There's no need or reason to call | |
2335 | * ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe() in this case as mac80211 assumes the | |
2336 | * session is gone and removes the station. | |
2337 | * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_FLUSH_CONT: called when TX aggregation is stopped | |
2338 | * but the driver hasn't called ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe() yet and | |
2339 | * now the connection is dropped and the station will be removed. Drivers | |
2340 | * should clean up and drop remaining packets when this is called. | |
1b7d03ac RR |
2341 | */ |
2342 | enum ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action { | |
2343 | IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START, | |
2344 | IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_STOP, | |
0df3ef45 | 2345 | IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START, |
18b559d5 JB |
2346 | IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_CONT, |
2347 | IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_FLUSH, | |
2348 | IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_FLUSH_CONT, | |
b1720231 | 2349 | IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL, |
1b7d03ac | 2350 | }; |
75a5f0cc | 2351 | |
4049e09a JB |
2352 | /** |
2353 | * enum ieee80211_frame_release_type - frame release reason | |
2354 | * @IEEE80211_FRAME_RELEASE_PSPOLL: frame released for PS-Poll | |
47086fc5 JB |
2355 | * @IEEE80211_FRAME_RELEASE_UAPSD: frame(s) released due to |
2356 | * frame received on trigger-enabled AC | |
4049e09a JB |
2357 | */ |
2358 | enum ieee80211_frame_release_type { | |
2359 | IEEE80211_FRAME_RELEASE_PSPOLL, | |
47086fc5 | 2360 | IEEE80211_FRAME_RELEASE_UAPSD, |
4049e09a JB |
2361 | }; |
2362 | ||
8f727ef3 JB |
2363 | /** |
2364 | * enum ieee80211_rate_control_changed - flags to indicate what changed | |
2365 | * | |
2366 | * @IEEE80211_RC_BW_CHANGED: The bandwidth that can be used to transmit | |
e1a0c6b3 JB |
2367 | * to this station changed. The actual bandwidth is in the station |
2368 | * information -- for HT20/40 the IEEE80211_HT_CAP_SUP_WIDTH_20_40 | |
2369 | * flag changes, for HT and VHT the bandwidth field changes. | |
8f727ef3 | 2370 | * @IEEE80211_RC_SMPS_CHANGED: The SMPS state of the station changed. |
e687f61e AQ |
2371 | * @IEEE80211_RC_SUPP_RATES_CHANGED: The supported rate set of this peer |
2372 | * changed (in IBSS mode) due to discovering more information about | |
2373 | * the peer. | |
0af83d3d JB |
2374 | * @IEEE80211_RC_NSS_CHANGED: N_SS (number of spatial streams) was changed |
2375 | * by the peer | |
8f727ef3 JB |
2376 | */ |
2377 | enum ieee80211_rate_control_changed { | |
2378 | IEEE80211_RC_BW_CHANGED = BIT(0), | |
2379 | IEEE80211_RC_SMPS_CHANGED = BIT(1), | |
e687f61e | 2380 | IEEE80211_RC_SUPP_RATES_CHANGED = BIT(2), |
0af83d3d | 2381 | IEEE80211_RC_NSS_CHANGED = BIT(3), |
8f727ef3 JB |
2382 | }; |
2383 | ||
d339d5ca IP |
2384 | /** |
2385 | * enum ieee80211_roc_type - remain on channel type | |
2386 | * | |
2387 | * With the support for multi channel contexts and multi channel operations, | |
2388 | * remain on channel operations might be limited/deferred/aborted by other | |
2389 | * flows/operations which have higher priority (and vise versa). | |
2390 | * Specifying the ROC type can be used by devices to prioritize the ROC | |
2391 | * operations compared to other operations/flows. | |
2392 | * | |
2393 | * @IEEE80211_ROC_TYPE_NORMAL: There are no special requirements for this ROC. | |
2394 | * @IEEE80211_ROC_TYPE_MGMT_TX: The remain on channel request is required | |
2395 | * for sending managment frames offchannel. | |
2396 | */ | |
2397 | enum ieee80211_roc_type { | |
2398 | IEEE80211_ROC_TYPE_NORMAL = 0, | |
2399 | IEEE80211_ROC_TYPE_MGMT_TX, | |
2400 | }; | |
2401 | ||
75a5f0cc JB |
2402 | /** |
2403 | * struct ieee80211_ops - callbacks from mac80211 to the driver | |
2404 | * | |
2405 | * This structure contains various callbacks that the driver may | |
2406 | * handle or, in some cases, must handle, for example to configure | |
2407 | * the hardware to a new channel or to transmit a frame. | |
2408 | * | |
2409 | * @tx: Handler that 802.11 module calls for each transmitted frame. | |
2410 | * skb contains the buffer starting from the IEEE 802.11 header. | |
2411 | * The low-level driver should send the frame out based on | |
eefce91a | 2412 | * configuration in the TX control data. This handler should, |
11127e91 | 2413 | * preferably, never fail and stop queues appropriately. |
11127e91 | 2414 | * Must be atomic. |
75a5f0cc JB |
2415 | * |
2416 | * @start: Called before the first netdevice attached to the hardware | |
2417 | * is enabled. This should turn on the hardware and must turn on | |
2418 | * frame reception (for possibly enabled monitor interfaces.) | |
2419 | * Returns negative error codes, these may be seen in userspace, | |
2420 | * or zero. | |
2421 | * When the device is started it should not have a MAC address | |
2422 | * to avoid acknowledging frames before a non-monitor device | |
2423 | * is added. | |
e1781ed3 | 2424 | * Must be implemented and can sleep. |
75a5f0cc JB |
2425 | * |
2426 | * @stop: Called after last netdevice attached to the hardware | |
2427 | * is disabled. This should turn off the hardware (at least | |
2428 | * it must turn off frame reception.) | |
2429 | * May be called right after add_interface if that rejects | |
42935eca LR |
2430 | * an interface. If you added any work onto the mac80211 workqueue |
2431 | * you should ensure to cancel it on this callback. | |
e1781ed3 | 2432 | * Must be implemented and can sleep. |
75a5f0cc | 2433 | * |
eecc4800 JB |
2434 | * @suspend: Suspend the device; mac80211 itself will quiesce before and |
2435 | * stop transmitting and doing any other configuration, and then | |
2436 | * ask the device to suspend. This is only invoked when WoWLAN is | |
2437 | * configured, otherwise the device is deconfigured completely and | |
2438 | * reconfigured at resume time. | |
2b4562df JB |
2439 | * The driver may also impose special conditions under which it |
2440 | * wants to use the "normal" suspend (deconfigure), say if it only | |
2441 | * supports WoWLAN when the device is associated. In this case, it | |
2442 | * must return 1 from this function. | |
eecc4800 JB |
2443 | * |
2444 | * @resume: If WoWLAN was configured, this indicates that mac80211 is | |
2445 | * now resuming its operation, after this the device must be fully | |
2446 | * functional again. If this returns an error, the only way out is | |
2447 | * to also unregister the device. If it returns 1, then mac80211 | |
2448 | * will also go through the regular complete restart on resume. | |
2449 | * | |
d13e1414 JB |
2450 | * @set_wakeup: Enable or disable wakeup when WoWLAN configuration is |
2451 | * modified. The reason is that device_set_wakeup_enable() is | |
2452 | * supposed to be called when the configuration changes, not only | |
2453 | * in suspend(). | |
2454 | * | |
75a5f0cc | 2455 | * @add_interface: Called when a netdevice attached to the hardware is |
e37d4dff | 2456 | * enabled. Because it is not called for monitor mode devices, @start |
75a5f0cc JB |
2457 | * and @stop must be implemented. |
2458 | * The driver should perform any initialization it needs before | |
2459 | * the device can be enabled. The initial configuration for the | |
2460 | * interface is given in the conf parameter. | |
2461 | * The callback may refuse to add an interface by returning a | |
2462 | * negative error code (which will be seen in userspace.) | |
e1781ed3 | 2463 | * Must be implemented and can sleep. |
75a5f0cc | 2464 | * |
34d4bc4d JB |
2465 | * @change_interface: Called when a netdevice changes type. This callback |
2466 | * is optional, but only if it is supported can interface types be | |
2467 | * switched while the interface is UP. The callback may sleep. | |
2468 | * Note that while an interface is being switched, it will not be | |
2469 | * found by the interface iteration callbacks. | |
2470 | * | |
75a5f0cc JB |
2471 | * @remove_interface: Notifies a driver that an interface is going down. |
2472 | * The @stop callback is called after this if it is the last interface | |
2473 | * and no monitor interfaces are present. | |
2474 | * When all interfaces are removed, the MAC address in the hardware | |
2475 | * must be cleared so the device no longer acknowledges packets, | |
2476 | * the mac_addr member of the conf structure is, however, set to the | |
2477 | * MAC address of the device going away. | |
e1781ed3 | 2478 | * Hence, this callback must be implemented. It can sleep. |
75a5f0cc JB |
2479 | * |
2480 | * @config: Handler for configuration requests. IEEE 802.11 code calls this | |
2481 | * function to change hardware configuration, e.g., channel. | |
6dd1bf31 | 2482 | * This function should never fail but returns a negative error code |
e1781ed3 | 2483 | * if it does. The callback can sleep. |
75a5f0cc | 2484 | * |
471b3efd JB |
2485 | * @bss_info_changed: Handler for configuration requests related to BSS |
2486 | * parameters that may vary during BSS's lifespan, and may affect low | |
2487 | * level driver (e.g. assoc/disassoc status, erp parameters). | |
2488 | * This function should not be used if no BSS has been set, unless | |
2489 | * for association indication. The @changed parameter indicates which | |
e1781ed3 KV |
2490 | * of the bss parameters has changed when a call is made. The callback |
2491 | * can sleep. | |
471b3efd | 2492 | * |
3ac64bee JB |
2493 | * @prepare_multicast: Prepare for multicast filter configuration. |
2494 | * This callback is optional, and its return value is passed | |
2495 | * to configure_filter(). This callback must be atomic. | |
2496 | * | |
75a5f0cc JB |
2497 | * @configure_filter: Configure the device's RX filter. |
2498 | * See the section "Frame filtering" for more information. | |
e1781ed3 | 2499 | * This callback must be implemented and can sleep. |
75a5f0cc | 2500 | * |
546c80c9 | 2501 | * @set_tim: Set TIM bit. mac80211 calls this function when a TIM bit |
17741cdc | 2502 | * must be set or cleared for a given STA. Must be atomic. |
75a5f0cc JB |
2503 | * |
2504 | * @set_key: See the section "Hardware crypto acceleration" | |
e1781ed3 KV |
2505 | * This callback is only called between add_interface and |
2506 | * remove_interface calls, i.e. while the given virtual interface | |
dc822b5d | 2507 | * is enabled. |
6dd1bf31 | 2508 | * Returns a negative error code if the key can't be added. |
e1781ed3 | 2509 | * The callback can sleep. |
75a5f0cc | 2510 | * |
9ae4fda3 EG |
2511 | * @update_tkip_key: See the section "Hardware crypto acceleration" |
2512 | * This callback will be called in the context of Rx. Called for drivers | |
2513 | * which set IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_TKIP_REQ_RX_P1_KEY. | |
eb807fb2 | 2514 | * The callback must be atomic. |
9ae4fda3 | 2515 | * |
c68f4b89 JB |
2516 | * @set_rekey_data: If the device supports GTK rekeying, for example while the |
2517 | * host is suspended, it can assign this callback to retrieve the data | |
2518 | * necessary to do GTK rekeying, this is the KEK, KCK and replay counter. | |
2519 | * After rekeying was done it should (for example during resume) notify | |
2520 | * userspace of the new replay counter using ieee80211_gtk_rekey_notify(). | |
2521 | * | |
de5fad81 YD |
2522 | * @set_default_unicast_key: Set the default (unicast) key index, useful for |
2523 | * WEP when the device sends data packets autonomously, e.g. for ARP | |
2524 | * offloading. The index can be 0-3, or -1 for unsetting it. | |
2525 | * | |
75a5f0cc | 2526 | * @hw_scan: Ask the hardware to service the scan request, no need to start |
8318d78a | 2527 | * the scan state machine in stack. The scan must honour the channel |
9050bdd8 KV |
2528 | * configuration done by the regulatory agent in the wiphy's |
2529 | * registered bands. The hardware (or the driver) needs to make sure | |
de95a54b JB |
2530 | * that power save is disabled. |
2531 | * The @req ie/ie_len members are rewritten by mac80211 to contain the | |
2532 | * entire IEs after the SSID, so that drivers need not look at these | |
2533 | * at all but just send them after the SSID -- mac80211 includes the | |
2534 | * (extended) supported rates and HT information (where applicable). | |
2535 | * When the scan finishes, ieee80211_scan_completed() must be called; | |
2536 | * note that it also must be called when the scan cannot finish due to | |
2537 | * any error unless this callback returned a negative error code. | |
e1781ed3 | 2538 | * The callback can sleep. |
75a5f0cc | 2539 | * |
b856439b EP |
2540 | * @cancel_hw_scan: Ask the low-level tp cancel the active hw scan. |
2541 | * The driver should ask the hardware to cancel the scan (if possible), | |
2542 | * but the scan will be completed only after the driver will call | |
2543 | * ieee80211_scan_completed(). | |
2544 | * This callback is needed for wowlan, to prevent enqueueing a new | |
2545 | * scan_work after the low-level driver was already suspended. | |
2546 | * The callback can sleep. | |
2547 | * | |
79f460ca LC |
2548 | * @sched_scan_start: Ask the hardware to start scanning repeatedly at |
2549 | * specific intervals. The driver must call the | |
2550 | * ieee80211_sched_scan_results() function whenever it finds results. | |
2551 | * This process will continue until sched_scan_stop is called. | |
2552 | * | |
2553 | * @sched_scan_stop: Tell the hardware to stop an ongoing scheduled scan. | |
37e3308c | 2554 | * In this case, ieee80211_sched_scan_stopped() must not be called. |
79f460ca | 2555 | * |
80e775bf MB |
2556 | * @sw_scan_start: Notifier function that is called just before a software scan |
2557 | * is started. Can be NULL, if the driver doesn't need this notification. | |
e1781ed3 | 2558 | * The callback can sleep. |
80e775bf | 2559 | * |
e1781ed3 KV |
2560 | * @sw_scan_complete: Notifier function that is called just after a |
2561 | * software scan finished. Can be NULL, if the driver doesn't need | |
2562 | * this notification. | |
2563 | * The callback can sleep. | |
80e775bf | 2564 | * |
6dd1bf31 BC |
2565 | * @get_stats: Return low-level statistics. |
2566 | * Returns zero if statistics are available. | |
e1781ed3 | 2567 | * The callback can sleep. |
75a5f0cc | 2568 | * |
62da92fb JB |
2569 | * @get_tkip_seq: If your device implements TKIP encryption in hardware this |
2570 | * callback should be provided to read the TKIP transmit IVs (both IV32 | |
2571 | * and IV16) for the given key from hardware. | |
e1781ed3 | 2572 | * The callback must be atomic. |
75a5f0cc | 2573 | * |
f23a4780 AN |
2574 | * @set_frag_threshold: Configuration of fragmentation threshold. Assign this |
2575 | * if the device does fragmentation by itself; if this callback is | |
2576 | * implemented then the stack will not do fragmentation. | |
2577 | * The callback can sleep. | |
2578 | * | |
75a5f0cc | 2579 | * @set_rts_threshold: Configuration of RTS threshold (if device needs it) |
e1781ed3 | 2580 | * The callback can sleep. |
75a5f0cc | 2581 | * |
34e89507 JB |
2582 | * @sta_add: Notifies low level driver about addition of an associated station, |
2583 | * AP, IBSS/WDS/mesh peer etc. This callback can sleep. | |
2584 | * | |
2585 | * @sta_remove: Notifies low level driver about removal of an associated | |
6a9d1b91 JB |
2586 | * station, AP, IBSS/WDS/mesh peer etc. Note that after the callback |
2587 | * returns it isn't safe to use the pointer, not even RCU protected; | |
2588 | * no RCU grace period is guaranteed between returning here and freeing | |
2589 | * the station. See @sta_pre_rcu_remove if needed. | |
2590 | * This callback can sleep. | |
34e89507 | 2591 | * |
77d2ece6 SM |
2592 | * @sta_add_debugfs: Drivers can use this callback to add debugfs files |
2593 | * when a station is added to mac80211's station list. This callback | |
2594 | * and @sta_remove_debugfs should be within a CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS | |
2595 | * conditional. This callback can sleep. | |
2596 | * | |
2597 | * @sta_remove_debugfs: Remove the debugfs files which were added using | |
2598 | * @sta_add_debugfs. This callback can sleep. | |
2599 | * | |
34e89507 | 2600 | * @sta_notify: Notifies low level driver about power state transition of an |
d057e5a3 AN |
2601 | * associated station, AP, IBSS/WDS/mesh peer etc. For a VIF operating |
2602 | * in AP mode, this callback will not be called when the flag | |
2603 | * %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS is set. Must be atomic. | |
4571d3bf | 2604 | * |
f09603a2 JB |
2605 | * @sta_state: Notifies low level driver about state transition of a |
2606 | * station (which can be the AP, a client, IBSS/WDS/mesh peer etc.) | |
2607 | * This callback is mutually exclusive with @sta_add/@sta_remove. | |
2608 | * It must not fail for down transitions but may fail for transitions | |
6a9d1b91 JB |
2609 | * up the list of states. Also note that after the callback returns it |
2610 | * isn't safe to use the pointer, not even RCU protected - no RCU grace | |
2611 | * period is guaranteed between returning here and freeing the station. | |
2612 | * See @sta_pre_rcu_remove if needed. | |
2613 | * The callback can sleep. | |
2614 | * | |
2615 | * @sta_pre_rcu_remove: Notify driver about station removal before RCU | |
2616 | * synchronisation. This is useful if a driver needs to have station | |
2617 | * pointers protected using RCU, it can then use this call to clear | |
2618 | * the pointers instead of waiting for an RCU grace period to elapse | |
2619 | * in @sta_state. | |
f09603a2 JB |
2620 | * The callback can sleep. |
2621 | * | |
8f727ef3 JB |
2622 | * @sta_rc_update: Notifies the driver of changes to the bitrates that can be |
2623 | * used to transmit to the station. The changes are advertised with bits | |
2624 | * from &enum ieee80211_rate_control_changed and the values are reflected | |
2625 | * in the station data. This callback should only be used when the driver | |
2626 | * uses hardware rate control (%IEEE80211_HW_HAS_RATE_CONTROL) since | |
2627 | * otherwise the rate control algorithm is notified directly. | |
2628 | * Must be atomic. | |
2629 | * | |
75a5f0cc | 2630 | * @conf_tx: Configure TX queue parameters (EDCF (aifs, cw_min, cw_max), |
fe3fa827 | 2631 | * bursting) for a hardware TX queue. |
6dd1bf31 | 2632 | * Returns a negative error code on failure. |
e1781ed3 | 2633 | * The callback can sleep. |
75a5f0cc | 2634 | * |
75a5f0cc | 2635 | * @get_tsf: Get the current TSF timer value from firmware/hardware. Currently, |
3b5d665b | 2636 | * this is only used for IBSS mode BSSID merging and debugging. Is not a |
7b08b3b4 | 2637 | * required function. |
e1781ed3 | 2638 | * The callback can sleep. |
3b5d665b AF |
2639 | * |
2640 | * @set_tsf: Set the TSF timer to the specified value in the firmware/hardware. | |
ad24b0da | 2641 | * Currently, this is only used for IBSS mode debugging. Is not a |
7b08b3b4 | 2642 | * required function. |
e1781ed3 | 2643 | * The callback can sleep. |
75a5f0cc JB |
2644 | * |
2645 | * @reset_tsf: Reset the TSF timer and allow firmware/hardware to synchronize | |
2646 | * with other STAs in the IBSS. This is only used in IBSS mode. This | |
2647 | * function is optional if the firmware/hardware takes full care of | |
2648 | * TSF synchronization. | |
e1781ed3 | 2649 | * The callback can sleep. |
75a5f0cc | 2650 | * |
75a5f0cc JB |
2651 | * @tx_last_beacon: Determine whether the last IBSS beacon was sent by us. |
2652 | * This is needed only for IBSS mode and the result of this function is | |
2653 | * used to determine whether to reply to Probe Requests. | |
6dd1bf31 | 2654 | * Returns non-zero if this device sent the last beacon. |
e1781ed3 | 2655 | * The callback can sleep. |
d3c990fb | 2656 | * |
1b7d03ac RR |
2657 | * @ampdu_action: Perform a certain A-MPDU action |
2658 | * The RA/TID combination determines the destination and TID we want | |
2659 | * the ampdu action to be performed for. The action is defined through | |
2660 | * ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action. Starting sequence number (@ssn) | |
6dd1bf31 | 2661 | * is the first frame we expect to perform the action on. Notice |
0df3ef45 | 2662 | * that TX/RX_STOP can pass NULL for this parameter. |
0b01f030 JB |
2663 | * The @buf_size parameter is only valid when the action is set to |
2664 | * %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL and indicates the peer's reorder | |
5312c3f6 JB |
2665 | * buffer size (number of subframes) for this session -- the driver |
2666 | * may neither send aggregates containing more subframes than this | |
2667 | * nor send aggregates in a way that lost frames would exceed the | |
2668 | * buffer size. If just limiting the aggregate size, this would be | |
2669 | * possible with a buf_size of 8: | |
2670 | * - TX: 1.....7 | |
2671 | * - RX: 2....7 (lost frame #1) | |
2672 | * - TX: 8..1... | |
2673 | * which is invalid since #1 was now re-transmitted well past the | |
2674 | * buffer size of 8. Correct ways to retransmit #1 would be: | |
2675 | * - TX: 1 or 18 or 81 | |
2676 | * Even "189" would be wrong since 1 could be lost again. | |
2677 | * | |
6dd1bf31 | 2678 | * Returns a negative error code on failure. |
85ad181e | 2679 | * The callback can sleep. |
1f87f7d3 | 2680 | * |
4e8998f0 RD |
2681 | * @get_survey: Return per-channel survey information |
2682 | * | |
1f87f7d3 JB |
2683 | * @rfkill_poll: Poll rfkill hardware state. If you need this, you also |
2684 | * need to set wiphy->rfkill_poll to %true before registration, | |
2685 | * and need to call wiphy_rfkill_set_hw_state() in the callback. | |
e1781ed3 | 2686 | * The callback can sleep. |
aff89a9b | 2687 | * |
310bc676 LT |
2688 | * @set_coverage_class: Set slot time for given coverage class as specified |
2689 | * in IEEE 802.11-2007 section 17.3.8.6 and modify ACK timeout | |
2690 | * accordingly. This callback is not required and may sleep. | |
2691 | * | |
52981cd7 DS |
2692 | * @testmode_cmd: Implement a cfg80211 test mode command. The passed @vif may |
2693 | * be %NULL. The callback can sleep. | |
71063f0e | 2694 | * @testmode_dump: Implement a cfg80211 test mode dump. The callback can sleep. |
a80f7c0b JB |
2695 | * |
2696 | * @flush: Flush all pending frames from the hardware queue, making sure | |
39ecc01d JB |
2697 | * that the hardware queues are empty. The @queues parameter is a bitmap |
2698 | * of queues to flush, which is useful if different virtual interfaces | |
2699 | * use different hardware queues; it may also indicate all queues. | |
2700 | * If the parameter @drop is set to %true, pending frames may be dropped. | |
77be2c54 | 2701 | * Note that vif can be NULL. |
39ecc01d | 2702 | * The callback can sleep. |
5ce6e438 JB |
2703 | * |
2704 | * @channel_switch: Drivers that need (or want) to offload the channel | |
2705 | * switch operation for CSAs received from the AP may implement this | |
2706 | * callback. They must then call ieee80211_chswitch_done() to indicate | |
2707 | * completion of the channel switch. | |
4e6cbfd0 | 2708 | * |
79b1c460 BR |
2709 | * @set_antenna: Set antenna configuration (tx_ant, rx_ant) on the device. |
2710 | * Parameters are bitmaps of allowed antennas to use for TX/RX. Drivers may | |
2711 | * reject TX/RX mask combinations they cannot support by returning -EINVAL | |
2712 | * (also see nl80211.h @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_TX). | |
2713 | * | |
2714 | * @get_antenna: Get current antenna configuration from device (tx_ant, rx_ant). | |
4976b4eb JB |
2715 | * |
2716 | * @remain_on_channel: Starts an off-channel period on the given channel, must | |
2717 | * call back to ieee80211_ready_on_channel() when on that channel. Note | |
2718 | * that normal channel traffic is not stopped as this is intended for hw | |
2719 | * offload. Frames to transmit on the off-channel channel are transmitted | |
2720 | * normally except for the %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_TX_OFFCHAN flag. When the | |
2721 | * duration (which will always be non-zero) expires, the driver must call | |
196ac1c1 | 2722 | * ieee80211_remain_on_channel_expired(). |
196ac1c1 JB |
2723 | * Note that this callback may be called while the device is in IDLE and |
2724 | * must be accepted in this case. | |
2725 | * This callback may sleep. | |
4976b4eb JB |
2726 | * @cancel_remain_on_channel: Requests that an ongoing off-channel period is |
2727 | * aborted before it expires. This callback may sleep. | |
38c09159 JL |
2728 | * |
2729 | * @set_ringparam: Set tx and rx ring sizes. | |
2730 | * | |
2731 | * @get_ringparam: Get tx and rx ring current and maximum sizes. | |
e8306f98 VN |
2732 | * |
2733 | * @tx_frames_pending: Check if there is any pending frame in the hardware | |
2734 | * queues before entering power save. | |
bdbfd6b5 SM |
2735 | * |
2736 | * @set_bitrate_mask: Set a mask of rates to be used for rate control selection | |
2737 | * when transmitting a frame. Currently only legacy rates are handled. | |
2738 | * The callback can sleep. | |
615f7b9b MV |
2739 | * @rssi_callback: Notify driver when the average RSSI goes above/below |
2740 | * thresholds that were registered previously. The callback can sleep. | |
4049e09a JB |
2741 | * |
2742 | * @release_buffered_frames: Release buffered frames according to the given | |
2743 | * parameters. In the case where the driver buffers some frames for | |
2744 | * sleeping stations mac80211 will use this callback to tell the driver | |
2745 | * to release some frames, either for PS-poll or uAPSD. | |
e227867f | 2746 | * Note that if the @more_data parameter is %false the driver must check |
4049e09a JB |
2747 | * if there are more frames on the given TIDs, and if there are more than |
2748 | * the frames being released then it must still set the more-data bit in | |
2749 | * the frame. If the @more_data parameter is %true, then of course the | |
2750 | * more-data bit must always be set. | |
2751 | * The @tids parameter tells the driver which TIDs to release frames | |
2752 | * from, for PS-poll it will always have only a single bit set. | |
deeaee19 JB |
2753 | * In the case this is used for a PS-poll initiated release, the |
2754 | * @num_frames parameter will always be 1 so code can be shared. In | |
2755 | * this case the driver must also set %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP flag | |
2756 | * on the TX status (and must report TX status) so that the PS-poll | |
2757 | * period is properly ended. This is used to avoid sending multiple | |
2758 | * responses for a retried PS-poll frame. | |
4049e09a JB |
2759 | * In the case this is used for uAPSD, the @num_frames parameter may be |
2760 | * bigger than one, but the driver may send fewer frames (it must send | |
2761 | * at least one, however). In this case it is also responsible for | |
47086fc5 JB |
2762 | * setting the EOSP flag in the QoS header of the frames. Also, when the |
2763 | * service period ends, the driver must set %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP | |
37fbd908 | 2764 | * on the last frame in the SP. Alternatively, it may call the function |
e943789e | 2765 | * ieee80211_sta_eosp() to inform mac80211 of the end of the SP. |
4049e09a | 2766 | * This callback must be atomic. |
40b96408 JB |
2767 | * @allow_buffered_frames: Prepare device to allow the given number of frames |
2768 | * to go out to the given station. The frames will be sent by mac80211 | |
2769 | * via the usual TX path after this call. The TX information for frames | |
02f2f1a9 | 2770 | * released will also have the %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER flag set |
40b96408 JB |
2771 | * and the last one will also have %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP set. In case |
2772 | * frames from multiple TIDs are released and the driver might reorder | |
2773 | * them between the TIDs, it must set the %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP flag | |
2774 | * on the last frame and clear it on all others and also handle the EOSP | |
37fbd908 | 2775 | * bit in the QoS header correctly. Alternatively, it can also call the |
e943789e | 2776 | * ieee80211_sta_eosp() function. |
40b96408 JB |
2777 | * The @tids parameter is a bitmap and tells the driver which TIDs the |
2778 | * frames will be on; it will at most have two bits set. | |
2779 | * This callback must be atomic. | |
e352114f BG |
2780 | * |
2781 | * @get_et_sset_count: Ethtool API to get string-set count. | |
2782 | * | |
2783 | * @get_et_stats: Ethtool API to get a set of u64 stats. | |
2784 | * | |
2785 | * @get_et_strings: Ethtool API to get a set of strings to describe stats | |
2786 | * and perhaps other supported types of ethtool data-sets. | |
2787 | * | |
66572cfc VG |
2788 | * @get_rssi: Get current signal strength in dBm, the function is optional |
2789 | * and can sleep. | |
2790 | * | |
a1845fc7 JB |
2791 | * @mgd_prepare_tx: Prepare for transmitting a management frame for association |
2792 | * before associated. In multi-channel scenarios, a virtual interface is | |
2793 | * bound to a channel before it is associated, but as it isn't associated | |
2794 | * yet it need not necessarily be given airtime, in particular since any | |
2795 | * transmission to a P2P GO needs to be synchronized against the GO's | |
2796 | * powersave state. mac80211 will call this function before transmitting a | |
2797 | * management frame prior to having successfully associated to allow the | |
2798 | * driver to give it channel time for the transmission, to get a response | |
2799 | * and to be able to synchronize with the GO. | |
2800 | * The callback will be called before each transmission and upon return | |
2801 | * mac80211 will transmit the frame right away. | |
2802 | * The callback is optional and can (should!) sleep. | |
c3645eac | 2803 | * |
ee10f2c7 AN |
2804 | * @mgd_protect_tdls_discover: Protect a TDLS discovery session. After sending |
2805 | * a TDLS discovery-request, we expect a reply to arrive on the AP's | |
2806 | * channel. We must stay on the channel (no PSM, scan, etc.), since a TDLS | |
2807 | * setup-response is a direct packet not buffered by the AP. | |
2808 | * mac80211 will call this function just before the transmission of a TDLS | |
2809 | * discovery-request. The recommended period of protection is at least | |
2810 | * 2 * (DTIM period). | |
2811 | * The callback is optional and can sleep. | |
2812 | * | |
c3645eac MK |
2813 | * @add_chanctx: Notifies device driver about new channel context creation. |
2814 | * @remove_chanctx: Notifies device driver about channel context destruction. | |
2815 | * @change_chanctx: Notifies device driver about channel context changes that | |
2816 | * may happen when combining different virtual interfaces on the same | |
2817 | * channel context with different settings | |
2818 | * @assign_vif_chanctx: Notifies device driver about channel context being bound | |
2819 | * to vif. Possible use is for hw queue remapping. | |
2820 | * @unassign_vif_chanctx: Notifies device driver about channel context being | |
2821 | * unbound from vif. | |
1a5f0c13 LC |
2822 | * @switch_vif_chanctx: switch a number of vifs from one chanctx to |
2823 | * another, as specified in the list of | |
2824 | * @ieee80211_vif_chanctx_switch passed to the driver, according | |
2825 | * to the mode defined in &ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode. | |
2826 | * | |
1041638f JB |
2827 | * @start_ap: Start operation on the AP interface, this is called after all the |
2828 | * information in bss_conf is set and beacon can be retrieved. A channel | |
2829 | * context is bound before this is called. Note that if the driver uses | |
2830 | * software scan or ROC, this (and @stop_ap) isn't called when the AP is | |
2831 | * just "paused" for scanning/ROC, which is indicated by the beacon being | |
2832 | * disabled/enabled via @bss_info_changed. | |
2833 | * @stop_ap: Stop operation on the AP interface. | |
9214ad7f JB |
2834 | * |
2835 | * @restart_complete: Called after a call to ieee80211_restart_hw(), when the | |
2836 | * reconfiguration has completed. This can help the driver implement the | |
8f21b0ad JB |
2837 | * reconfiguration step. Also called when reconfiguring because the |
2838 | * driver's resume function returned 1, as this is just like an "inline" | |
2839 | * hardware restart. This callback may sleep. | |
2840 | * | |
a65240c1 JB |
2841 | * @ipv6_addr_change: IPv6 address assignment on the given interface changed. |
2842 | * Currently, this is only called for managed or P2P client interfaces. | |
2843 | * This callback is optional; it must not sleep. | |
73da7d5b SW |
2844 | * |
2845 | * @channel_switch_beacon: Starts a channel switch to a new channel. | |
2846 | * Beacons are modified to include CSA or ECSA IEs before calling this | |
2847 | * function. The corresponding count fields in these IEs must be | |
66e01cf9 | 2848 | * decremented, and when they reach 1 the driver must call |
73da7d5b SW |
2849 | * ieee80211_csa_finish(). Drivers which use ieee80211_beacon_get() |
2850 | * get the csa counter decremented by mac80211, but must check if it is | |
66e01cf9 | 2851 | * 1 using ieee80211_csa_is_complete() after the beacon has been |
73da7d5b | 2852 | * transmitted and then call ieee80211_csa_finish(). |
66e01cf9 LC |
2853 | * If the CSA count starts as zero or 1, this function will not be called, |
2854 | * since there won't be any time to beacon before the switch anyway. | |
73da7d5b | 2855 | * |
55fff501 JB |
2856 | * @join_ibss: Join an IBSS (on an IBSS interface); this is called after all |
2857 | * information in bss_conf is set up and the beacon can be retrieved. A | |
2858 | * channel context is bound before this is called. | |
2859 | * @leave_ibss: Leave the IBSS again. | |
cca674d4 AQ |
2860 | * |
2861 | * @get_expected_throughput: extract the expected throughput towards the | |
2862 | * specified station. The returned value is expressed in Kbps. It returns 0 | |
2863 | * if the RC algorithm does not have proper data to provide. | |
75a5f0cc | 2864 | */ |
f0706e82 | 2865 | struct ieee80211_ops { |
36323f81 TH |
2866 | void (*tx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, |
2867 | struct ieee80211_tx_control *control, | |
2868 | struct sk_buff *skb); | |
4150c572 | 2869 | int (*start)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw); |
4150c572 | 2870 | void (*stop)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw); |
eecc4800 JB |
2871 | #ifdef CONFIG_PM |
2872 | int (*suspend)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct cfg80211_wowlan *wowlan); | |
2873 | int (*resume)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw); | |
6d52563f | 2874 | void (*set_wakeup)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, bool enabled); |
eecc4800 | 2875 | #endif |
f0706e82 | 2876 | int (*add_interface)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, |
1ed32e4f | 2877 | struct ieee80211_vif *vif); |
34d4bc4d JB |
2878 | int (*change_interface)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, |
2879 | struct ieee80211_vif *vif, | |
2ca27bcf | 2880 | enum nl80211_iftype new_type, bool p2p); |
f0706e82 | 2881 | void (*remove_interface)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, |
1ed32e4f | 2882 | struct ieee80211_vif *vif); |
e8975581 | 2883 | int (*config)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 changed); |
471b3efd JB |
2884 | void (*bss_info_changed)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, |
2885 | struct ieee80211_vif *vif, | |
2886 | struct ieee80211_bss_conf *info, | |
2887 | u32 changed); | |
b2abb6e2 | 2888 | |
1041638f JB |
2889 | int (*start_ap)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif); |
2890 | void (*stop_ap)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif); | |
2891 | ||
3ac64bee | 2892 | u64 (*prepare_multicast)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, |
22bedad3 | 2893 | struct netdev_hw_addr_list *mc_list); |
4150c572 JB |
2894 | void (*configure_filter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, |
2895 | unsigned int changed_flags, | |
2896 | unsigned int *total_flags, | |
3ac64bee | 2897 | u64 multicast); |
17741cdc JB |
2898 | int (*set_tim)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_sta *sta, |
2899 | bool set); | |
ea49c359 | 2900 | int (*set_key)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, enum set_key_cmd cmd, |
dc822b5d | 2901 | struct ieee80211_vif *vif, struct ieee80211_sta *sta, |
11a843b7 | 2902 | struct ieee80211_key_conf *key); |
9ae4fda3 | 2903 | void (*update_tkip_key)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, |
b3fbdcf4 JB |
2904 | struct ieee80211_vif *vif, |
2905 | struct ieee80211_key_conf *conf, | |
2906 | struct ieee80211_sta *sta, | |
2907 | u32 iv32, u16 *phase1key); | |
c68f4b89 JB |
2908 | void (*set_rekey_data)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, |
2909 | struct ieee80211_vif *vif, | |
2910 | struct cfg80211_gtk_rekey_data *data); | |
de5fad81 YD |
2911 | void (*set_default_unicast_key)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, |
2912 | struct ieee80211_vif *vif, int idx); | |
a060bbfe | 2913 | int (*hw_scan)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif, |
c56ef672 | 2914 | struct ieee80211_scan_request *req); |
b856439b EP |
2915 | void (*cancel_hw_scan)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, |
2916 | struct ieee80211_vif *vif); | |
79f460ca LC |
2917 | int (*sched_scan_start)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, |
2918 | struct ieee80211_vif *vif, | |
2919 | struct cfg80211_sched_scan_request *req, | |
2920 | struct ieee80211_sched_scan_ies *ies); | |
37e3308c | 2921 | int (*sched_scan_stop)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, |
79f460ca | 2922 | struct ieee80211_vif *vif); |
80e775bf MB |
2923 | void (*sw_scan_start)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw); |
2924 | void (*sw_scan_complete)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw); | |
f0706e82 JB |
2925 | int (*get_stats)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, |
2926 | struct ieee80211_low_level_stats *stats); | |
62da92fb JB |
2927 | void (*get_tkip_seq)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u8 hw_key_idx, |
2928 | u32 *iv32, u16 *iv16); | |
f23a4780 | 2929 | int (*set_frag_threshold)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 value); |
f0706e82 | 2930 | int (*set_rts_threshold)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 value); |
34e89507 JB |
2931 | int (*sta_add)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif, |
2932 | struct ieee80211_sta *sta); | |
2933 | int (*sta_remove)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif, | |
2934 | struct ieee80211_sta *sta); | |
77d2ece6 SM |
2935 | #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS |
2936 | void (*sta_add_debugfs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, | |
2937 | struct ieee80211_vif *vif, | |
2938 | struct ieee80211_sta *sta, | |
2939 | struct dentry *dir); | |
2940 | void (*sta_remove_debugfs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, | |
2941 | struct ieee80211_vif *vif, | |
2942 | struct ieee80211_sta *sta, | |
2943 | struct dentry *dir); | |
2944 | #endif | |
32bfd35d | 2945 | void (*sta_notify)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif, |
17741cdc | 2946 | enum sta_notify_cmd, struct ieee80211_sta *sta); |
f09603a2 JB |
2947 | int (*sta_state)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif, |
2948 | struct ieee80211_sta *sta, | |
2949 | enum ieee80211_sta_state old_state, | |
2950 | enum ieee80211_sta_state new_state); | |
6a9d1b91 JB |
2951 | void (*sta_pre_rcu_remove)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, |
2952 | struct ieee80211_vif *vif, | |
2953 | struct ieee80211_sta *sta); | |
8f727ef3 JB |
2954 | void (*sta_rc_update)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, |
2955 | struct ieee80211_vif *vif, | |
2956 | struct ieee80211_sta *sta, | |
2957 | u32 changed); | |
8a3a3c85 | 2958 | int (*conf_tx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, |
a3304b0a | 2959 | struct ieee80211_vif *vif, u16 ac, |
f0706e82 | 2960 | const struct ieee80211_tx_queue_params *params); |
37a41b4a EP |
2961 | u64 (*get_tsf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif); |
2962 | void (*set_tsf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif, | |
2963 | u64 tsf); | |
2964 | void (*reset_tsf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif); | |
f0706e82 | 2965 | int (*tx_last_beacon)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw); |
1b7d03ac | 2966 | int (*ampdu_action)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, |
c951ad35 | 2967 | struct ieee80211_vif *vif, |
1b7d03ac | 2968 | enum ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action action, |
0b01f030 JB |
2969 | struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u16 tid, u16 *ssn, |
2970 | u8 buf_size); | |
1289723e HS |
2971 | int (*get_survey)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int idx, |
2972 | struct survey_info *survey); | |
1f87f7d3 | 2973 | void (*rfkill_poll)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw); |
310bc676 | 2974 | void (*set_coverage_class)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u8 coverage_class); |
aff89a9b | 2975 | #ifdef CONFIG_NL80211_TESTMODE |
52981cd7 DS |
2976 | int (*testmode_cmd)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif, |
2977 | void *data, int len); | |
71063f0e WYG |
2978 | int (*testmode_dump)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct sk_buff *skb, |
2979 | struct netlink_callback *cb, | |
2980 | void *data, int len); | |
aff89a9b | 2981 | #endif |
77be2c54 EG |
2982 | void (*flush)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif, |
2983 | u32 queues, bool drop); | |
5ce6e438 JB |
2984 | void (*channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, |
2985 | struct ieee80211_channel_switch *ch_switch); | |
15d96753 BR |
2986 | int (*set_antenna)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 tx_ant, u32 rx_ant); |
2987 | int (*get_antenna)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 *tx_ant, u32 *rx_ant); | |
21f83589 JB |
2988 | |
2989 | int (*remain_on_channel)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, | |
49884568 | 2990 | struct ieee80211_vif *vif, |
21f83589 | 2991 | struct ieee80211_channel *chan, |
d339d5ca IP |
2992 | int duration, |
2993 | enum ieee80211_roc_type type); | |
21f83589 | 2994 | int (*cancel_remain_on_channel)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw); |
38c09159 JL |
2995 | int (*set_ringparam)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 tx, u32 rx); |
2996 | void (*get_ringparam)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, | |
2997 | u32 *tx, u32 *tx_max, u32 *rx, u32 *rx_max); | |
e8306f98 | 2998 | bool (*tx_frames_pending)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw); |
bdbfd6b5 SM |
2999 | int (*set_bitrate_mask)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif, |
3000 | const struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask *mask); | |
615f7b9b | 3001 | void (*rssi_callback)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, |
887da917 | 3002 | struct ieee80211_vif *vif, |
615f7b9b | 3003 | enum ieee80211_rssi_event rssi_event); |
4049e09a | 3004 | |
40b96408 JB |
3005 | void (*allow_buffered_frames)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, |
3006 | struct ieee80211_sta *sta, | |
3007 | u16 tids, int num_frames, | |
3008 | enum ieee80211_frame_release_type reason, | |
3009 | bool more_data); | |
4049e09a JB |
3010 | void (*release_buffered_frames)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, |
3011 | struct ieee80211_sta *sta, | |
3012 | u16 tids, int num_frames, | |
3013 | enum ieee80211_frame_release_type reason, | |
3014 | bool more_data); | |
e352114f BG |
3015 | |
3016 | int (*get_et_sset_count)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, | |
3017 | struct ieee80211_vif *vif, int sset); | |
3018 | void (*get_et_stats)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, | |
3019 | struct ieee80211_vif *vif, | |
3020 | struct ethtool_stats *stats, u64 *data); | |
3021 | void (*get_et_strings)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, | |
3022 | struct ieee80211_vif *vif, | |
3023 | u32 sset, u8 *data); | |
66572cfc VG |
3024 | int (*get_rssi)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif, |
3025 | struct ieee80211_sta *sta, s8 *rssi_dbm); | |
a1845fc7 JB |
3026 | |
3027 | void (*mgd_prepare_tx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, | |
3028 | struct ieee80211_vif *vif); | |
c3645eac | 3029 | |
ee10f2c7 AN |
3030 | void (*mgd_protect_tdls_discover)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, |
3031 | struct ieee80211_vif *vif); | |
3032 | ||
c3645eac MK |
3033 | int (*add_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, |
3034 | struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx); | |
3035 | void (*remove_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, | |
3036 | struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx); | |
3037 | void (*change_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, | |
3038 | struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx, | |
3039 | u32 changed); | |
3040 | int (*assign_vif_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, | |
3041 | struct ieee80211_vif *vif, | |
3042 | struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx); | |
3043 | void (*unassign_vif_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, | |
3044 | struct ieee80211_vif *vif, | |
3045 | struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx); | |
1a5f0c13 LC |
3046 | int (*switch_vif_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, |
3047 | struct ieee80211_vif_chanctx_switch *vifs, | |
3048 | int n_vifs, | |
3049 | enum ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode mode); | |
9214ad7f JB |
3050 | |
3051 | void (*restart_complete)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw); | |
a65240c1 JB |
3052 | |
3053 | #if IS_ENABLED(CONFIG_IPV6) | |
3054 | void (*ipv6_addr_change)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, | |
3055 | struct ieee80211_vif *vif, | |
3056 | struct inet6_dev *idev); | |
3057 | #endif | |
73da7d5b SW |
3058 | void (*channel_switch_beacon)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, |
3059 | struct ieee80211_vif *vif, | |
3060 | struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef); | |
55fff501 JB |
3061 | |
3062 | int (*join_ibss)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif); | |
3063 | void (*leave_ibss)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif); | |
cca674d4 | 3064 | u32 (*get_expected_throughput)(struct ieee80211_sta *sta); |
f0706e82 JB |
3065 | }; |
3066 | ||
75a5f0cc JB |
3067 | /** |
3068 | * ieee80211_alloc_hw - Allocate a new hardware device | |
3069 | * | |
3070 | * This must be called once for each hardware device. The returned pointer | |
3071 | * must be used to refer to this device when calling other functions. | |
3072 | * mac80211 allocates a private data area for the driver pointed to by | |
3073 | * @priv in &struct ieee80211_hw, the size of this area is given as | |
3074 | * @priv_data_len. | |
3075 | * | |
3076 | * @priv_data_len: length of private data | |
3077 | * @ops: callbacks for this device | |
0ae997dc YB |
3078 | * |
3079 | * Return: A pointer to the new hardware device, or %NULL on error. | |
f0706e82 JB |
3080 | */ |
3081 | struct ieee80211_hw *ieee80211_alloc_hw(size_t priv_data_len, | |
3082 | const struct ieee80211_ops *ops); | |
3083 | ||
75a5f0cc JB |
3084 | /** |
3085 | * ieee80211_register_hw - Register hardware device | |
3086 | * | |
dbbea671 JB |
3087 | * You must call this function before any other functions in |
3088 | * mac80211. Note that before a hardware can be registered, you | |
3089 | * need to fill the contained wiphy's information. | |
75a5f0cc JB |
3090 | * |
3091 | * @hw: the device to register as returned by ieee80211_alloc_hw() | |
0ae997dc YB |
3092 | * |
3093 | * Return: 0 on success. An error code otherwise. | |
75a5f0cc | 3094 | */ |
f0706e82 JB |
3095 | int ieee80211_register_hw(struct ieee80211_hw *hw); |
3096 | ||
e1e54068 JB |
3097 | /** |
3098 | * struct ieee80211_tpt_blink - throughput blink description | |
3099 | * @throughput: throughput in Kbit/sec | |
3100 | * @blink_time: blink time in milliseconds | |
3101 | * (full cycle, ie. one off + one on period) | |
3102 | */ | |
3103 | struct ieee80211_tpt_blink { | |
3104 | int throughput; | |
3105 | int blink_time; | |
3106 | }; | |
3107 | ||
67408c8c JB |
3108 | /** |
3109 | * enum ieee80211_tpt_led_trigger_flags - throughput trigger flags | |
3110 | * @IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_RADIO: enable blinking with radio | |
3111 | * @IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_WORK: enable blinking when working | |
3112 | * @IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_CONNECTED: enable blinking when at least one | |
3113 | * interface is connected in some way, including being an AP | |
3114 | */ | |
3115 | enum ieee80211_tpt_led_trigger_flags { | |
3116 | IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_RADIO = BIT(0), | |
3117 | IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_WORK = BIT(1), | |
3118 | IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_CONNECTED = BIT(2), | |
3119 | }; | |
3120 | ||
f0706e82 | 3121 | #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS |
10dd9b7c JP |
3122 | char *__ieee80211_get_tx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw); |
3123 | char *__ieee80211_get_rx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw); | |
3124 | char *__ieee80211_get_assoc_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw); | |
3125 | char *__ieee80211_get_radio_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw); | |
3126 | char *__ieee80211_create_tpt_led_trigger(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, | |
3127 | unsigned int flags, | |
3128 | const struct ieee80211_tpt_blink *blink_table, | |
3129 | unsigned int blink_table_len); | |
f0706e82 | 3130 | #endif |
75a5f0cc JB |
3131 | /** |
3132 | * ieee80211_get_tx_led_name - get name of TX LED | |
3133 | * | |
3134 | * mac80211 creates a transmit LED trigger for each wireless hardware | |
3135 | * that can be used to drive LEDs if your driver registers a LED device. | |
3136 | * This function returns the name (or %NULL if not configured for LEDs) | |
3137 | * of the trigger so you can automatically link the LED device. | |
3138 | * | |
3139 | * @hw: the hardware to get the LED trigger name for | |
0ae997dc YB |
3140 | * |
3141 | * Return: The name of the LED trigger. %NULL if not configured for LEDs. | |
75a5f0cc | 3142 | */ |
f0706e82 JB |
3143 | static inline char *ieee80211_get_tx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw) |
3144 | { | |
3145 | #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS | |
3146 | return __ieee80211_get_tx_led_name(hw); | |
3147 | #else | |
3148 | return NULL; | |
3149 | #endif | |
3150 | } | |
3151 | ||
75a5f0cc JB |
3152 | /** |
3153 | * ieee80211_get_rx_led_name - get name of RX LED | |
3154 | * | |
3155 | * mac80211 creates a receive LED trigger for each wireless hardware | |
3156 | * that can be used to drive LEDs if your driver registers a LED device. | |
3157 | * This function returns the name (or %NULL if not configured for LEDs) | |
3158 | * of the trigger so you can automatically link the LED device. | |
3159 | * | |
3160 | * @hw: the hardware to get the LED trigger name for | |
0ae997dc YB |
3161 | * |
3162 | * Return: The name of the LED trigger. %NULL if not configured for LEDs. | |
75a5f0cc | 3163 | */ |
f0706e82 JB |
3164 | static inline char *ieee80211_get_rx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw) |
3165 | { | |
3166 | #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS | |
3167 | return __ieee80211_get_rx_led_name(hw); | |
3168 | #else | |
3169 | return NULL; | |
3170 | #endif | |
3171 | } | |
3172 | ||
cdcb006f ID |
3173 | /** |
3174 | * ieee80211_get_assoc_led_name - get name of association LED | |
3175 | * | |
3176 | * mac80211 creates a association LED trigger for each wireless hardware | |
3177 | * that can be used to drive LEDs if your driver registers a LED device. | |
3178 | * This function returns the name (or %NULL if not configured for LEDs) | |
3179 | * of the trigger so you can automatically link the LED device. | |
3180 | * | |
3181 | * @hw: the hardware to get the LED trigger name for | |
0ae997dc YB |
3182 | * |
3183 | * Return: The name of the LED trigger. %NULL if not configured for LEDs. | |
cdcb006f | 3184 | */ |
47f0c502 MB |
3185 | static inline char *ieee80211_get_assoc_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw) |
3186 | { | |
3187 | #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS | |
3188 | return __ieee80211_get_assoc_led_name(hw); | |
3189 | #else | |
3190 | return NULL; | |
3191 | #endif | |
3192 | } | |
3193 | ||
cdcb006f ID |
3194 | /** |
3195 | * ieee80211_get_radio_led_name - get name of radio LED | |
3196 | * | |
3197 | * mac80211 creates a radio change LED trigger for each wireless hardware | |
3198 | * that can be used to drive LEDs if your driver registers a LED device. | |
3199 | * This function returns the name (or %NULL if not configured for LEDs) | |
3200 | * of the trigger so you can automatically link the LED device. | |
3201 | * | |
3202 | * @hw: the hardware to get the LED trigger name for | |
0ae997dc YB |
3203 | * |
3204 | * Return: The name of the LED trigger. %NULL if not configured for LEDs. | |
cdcb006f ID |
3205 | */ |
3206 | static inline char *ieee80211_get_radio_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw) | |
3207 | { | |
3208 | #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS | |
3209 | return __ieee80211_get_radio_led_name(hw); | |
3210 | #else | |
3211 | return NULL; | |
3212 | #endif | |
3213 | } | |
47f0c502 | 3214 | |
e1e54068 JB |
3215 | /** |
3216 | * ieee80211_create_tpt_led_trigger - create throughput LED trigger | |
3217 | * @hw: the hardware to create the trigger for | |
67408c8c | 3218 | * @flags: trigger flags, see &enum ieee80211_tpt_led_trigger_flags |
e1e54068 JB |
3219 | * @blink_table: the blink table -- needs to be ordered by throughput |
3220 | * @blink_table_len: size of the blink table | |
3221 | * | |
0ae997dc YB |
3222 | * Return: %NULL (in case of error, or if no LED triggers are |
3223 | * configured) or the name of the new trigger. | |
3224 | * | |
3225 | * Note: This function must be called before ieee80211_register_hw(). | |
e1e54068 JB |
3226 | */ |
3227 | static inline char * | |
67408c8c | 3228 | ieee80211_create_tpt_led_trigger(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, unsigned int flags, |
e1e54068 JB |
3229 | const struct ieee80211_tpt_blink *blink_table, |
3230 | unsigned int blink_table_len) | |
3231 | { | |
3232 | #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS | |
67408c8c | 3233 | return __ieee80211_create_tpt_led_trigger(hw, flags, blink_table, |
e1e54068 JB |
3234 | blink_table_len); |
3235 | #else | |
3236 | return NULL; | |
3237 | #endif | |
3238 | } | |
3239 | ||
75a5f0cc JB |
3240 | /** |
3241 | * ieee80211_unregister_hw - Unregister a hardware device | |
3242 | * | |
3243 | * This function instructs mac80211 to free allocated resources | |
3244 | * and unregister netdevices from the networking subsystem. | |
3245 | * | |
3246 | * @hw: the hardware to unregister | |
3247 | */ | |
f0706e82 JB |
3248 | void ieee80211_unregister_hw(struct ieee80211_hw *hw); |
3249 | ||
75a5f0cc JB |
3250 | /** |
3251 | * ieee80211_free_hw - free hardware descriptor | |
3252 | * | |
3253 | * This function frees everything that was allocated, including the | |
3254 | * private data for the driver. You must call ieee80211_unregister_hw() | |
6ef307bc | 3255 | * before calling this function. |
75a5f0cc JB |
3256 | * |
3257 | * @hw: the hardware to free | |
3258 | */ | |
f0706e82 JB |
3259 | void ieee80211_free_hw(struct ieee80211_hw *hw); |
3260 | ||
f2753ddb JB |
3261 | /** |
3262 | * ieee80211_restart_hw - restart hardware completely | |
3263 | * | |
3264 | * Call this function when the hardware was restarted for some reason | |
3265 | * (hardware error, ...) and the driver is unable to restore its state | |
3266 | * by itself. mac80211 assumes that at this point the driver/hardware | |
3267 | * is completely uninitialised and stopped, it starts the process by | |
3268 | * calling the ->start() operation. The driver will need to reset all | |
3269 | * internal state that it has prior to calling this function. | |
3270 | * | |
3271 | * @hw: the hardware to restart | |
3272 | */ | |
3273 | void ieee80211_restart_hw(struct ieee80211_hw *hw); | |
3274 | ||
06d181a8 JB |
3275 | /** |
3276 | * ieee80211_napi_add - initialize mac80211 NAPI context | |
3277 | * @hw: the hardware to initialize the NAPI context on | |
3278 | * @napi: the NAPI context to initialize | |
3279 | * @napi_dev: dummy NAPI netdevice, here to not waste the space if the | |
3280 | * driver doesn't use NAPI | |
3281 | * @poll: poll function | |
3282 | * @weight: default weight | |
4e6cbfd0 | 3283 | * |
06d181a8 | 3284 | * See also netif_napi_add(). |
4e6cbfd0 | 3285 | */ |
06d181a8 JB |
3286 | void ieee80211_napi_add(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct napi_struct *napi, |
3287 | struct net_device *napi_dev, | |
3288 | int (*poll)(struct napi_struct *, int), | |
3289 | int weight); | |
4e6cbfd0 | 3290 | |
75a5f0cc JB |
3291 | /** |
3292 | * ieee80211_rx - receive frame | |
3293 | * | |
3294 | * Use this function to hand received frames to mac80211. The receive | |
e3cf8b3f ZY |
3295 | * buffer in @skb must start with an IEEE 802.11 header. In case of a |
3296 | * paged @skb is used, the driver is recommended to put the ieee80211 | |
3297 | * header of the frame on the linear part of the @skb to avoid memory | |
3298 | * allocation and/or memcpy by the stack. | |
75a5f0cc | 3299 | * |
2485f710 | 3300 | * This function may not be called in IRQ context. Calls to this function |
e36e49f7 KV |
3301 | * for a single hardware must be synchronized against each other. Calls to |
3302 | * this function, ieee80211_rx_ni() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() may not be | |
f6b3d85f FF |
3303 | * mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with |
3304 | * ieee80211_tx_status() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni(). | |
75a5f0cc | 3305 | * |
e36e49f7 | 3306 | * In process context use instead ieee80211_rx_ni(). |
d20ef63d | 3307 | * |
75a5f0cc JB |
3308 | * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on |
3309 | * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call | |
75a5f0cc | 3310 | */ |
103bf9f7 | 3311 | void ieee80211_rx(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct sk_buff *skb); |
75a5f0cc JB |
3312 | |
3313 | /** | |
3314 | * ieee80211_rx_irqsafe - receive frame | |
3315 | * | |
3316 | * Like ieee80211_rx() but can be called in IRQ context | |
2485f710 JB |
3317 | * (internally defers to a tasklet.) |
3318 | * | |
e36e49f7 | 3319 | * Calls to this function, ieee80211_rx() or ieee80211_rx_ni() may not |
f6b3d85f FF |
3320 | * be mixed for a single hardware.Must not run concurrently with |
3321 | * ieee80211_tx_status() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni(). | |
75a5f0cc JB |
3322 | * |
3323 | * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on | |
3324 | * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call | |
75a5f0cc | 3325 | */ |
f1d58c25 | 3326 | void ieee80211_rx_irqsafe(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct sk_buff *skb); |
f0706e82 | 3327 | |
e36e49f7 KV |
3328 | /** |
3329 | * ieee80211_rx_ni - receive frame (in process context) | |
3330 | * | |
3331 | * Like ieee80211_rx() but can be called in process context | |
3332 | * (internally disables bottom halves). | |
3333 | * | |
3334 | * Calls to this function, ieee80211_rx() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() may | |
f6b3d85f FF |
3335 | * not be mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with |
3336 | * ieee80211_tx_status() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni(). | |
e36e49f7 KV |
3337 | * |
3338 | * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on | |
3339 | * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call | |
3340 | */ | |
3341 | static inline void ieee80211_rx_ni(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, | |
3342 | struct sk_buff *skb) | |
3343 | { | |
3344 | local_bh_disable(); | |
3345 | ieee80211_rx(hw, skb); | |
3346 | local_bh_enable(); | |
3347 | } | |
3348 | ||
d057e5a3 AN |
3349 | /** |
3350 | * ieee80211_sta_ps_transition - PS transition for connected sta | |
3351 | * | |
3352 | * When operating in AP mode with the %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS | |
3353 | * flag set, use this function to inform mac80211 about a connected station | |
3354 | * entering/leaving PS mode. | |
3355 | * | |
3356 | * This function may not be called in IRQ context or with softirqs enabled. | |
3357 | * | |
3358 | * Calls to this function for a single hardware must be synchronized against | |
3359 | * each other. | |
3360 | * | |
d057e5a3 AN |
3361 | * @sta: currently connected sta |
3362 | * @start: start or stop PS | |
0ae997dc YB |
3363 | * |
3364 | * Return: 0 on success. -EINVAL when the requested PS mode is already set. | |
d057e5a3 AN |
3365 | */ |
3366 | int ieee80211_sta_ps_transition(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, bool start); | |
3367 | ||
3368 | /** | |
3369 | * ieee80211_sta_ps_transition_ni - PS transition for connected sta | |
3370 | * (in process context) | |
3371 | * | |
3372 | * Like ieee80211_sta_ps_transition() but can be called in process context | |
3373 | * (internally disables bottom halves). Concurrent call restriction still | |
3374 | * applies. | |
3375 | * | |
3376 | * @sta: currently connected sta | |
3377 | * @start: start or stop PS | |
0ae997dc YB |
3378 | * |
3379 | * Return: Like ieee80211_sta_ps_transition(). | |
d057e5a3 AN |
3380 | */ |
3381 | static inline int ieee80211_sta_ps_transition_ni(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, | |
3382 | bool start) | |
3383 | { | |
3384 | int ret; | |
3385 | ||
3386 | local_bh_disable(); | |
3387 | ret = ieee80211_sta_ps_transition(sta, start); | |
3388 | local_bh_enable(); | |
3389 | ||
3390 | return ret; | |
3391 | } | |
3392 | ||
d24deb25 GW |
3393 | /* |
3394 | * The TX headroom reserved by mac80211 for its own tx_status functions. | |
3395 | * This is enough for the radiotap header. | |
3396 | */ | |
7f2a5e21 | 3397 | #define IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_HEADROOM 14 |
d24deb25 | 3398 | |
dcf55fb5 | 3399 | /** |
042ec453 | 3400 | * ieee80211_sta_set_buffered - inform mac80211 about driver-buffered frames |
bdfbe804 | 3401 | * @sta: &struct ieee80211_sta pointer for the sleeping station |
042ec453 JB |
3402 | * @tid: the TID that has buffered frames |
3403 | * @buffered: indicates whether or not frames are buffered for this TID | |
dcf55fb5 FF |
3404 | * |
3405 | * If a driver buffers frames for a powersave station instead of passing | |
042ec453 JB |
3406 | * them back to mac80211 for retransmission, the station may still need |
3407 | * to be told that there are buffered frames via the TIM bit. | |
3408 | * | |
3409 | * This function informs mac80211 whether or not there are frames that are | |
3410 | * buffered in the driver for a given TID; mac80211 can then use this data | |
3411 | * to set the TIM bit (NOTE: This may call back into the driver's set_tim | |
3412 | * call! Beware of the locking!) | |
3413 | * | |
3414 | * If all frames are released to the station (due to PS-poll or uAPSD) | |
3415 | * then the driver needs to inform mac80211 that there no longer are | |
3416 | * frames buffered. However, when the station wakes up mac80211 assumes | |
3417 | * that all buffered frames will be transmitted and clears this data, | |
3418 | * drivers need to make sure they inform mac80211 about all buffered | |
3419 | * frames on the sleep transition (sta_notify() with %STA_NOTIFY_SLEEP). | |
3420 | * | |
3421 | * Note that technically mac80211 only needs to know this per AC, not per | |
3422 | * TID, but since driver buffering will inevitably happen per TID (since | |
3423 | * it is related to aggregation) it is easier to make mac80211 map the | |
3424 | * TID to the AC as required instead of keeping track in all drivers that | |
3425 | * use this API. | |
3426 | */ | |
3427 | void ieee80211_sta_set_buffered(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, | |
3428 | u8 tid, bool buffered); | |
dcf55fb5 | 3429 | |
0d528d85 FF |
3430 | /** |
3431 | * ieee80211_get_tx_rates - get the selected transmit rates for a packet | |
3432 | * | |
3433 | * Call this function in a driver with per-packet rate selection support | |
3434 | * to combine the rate info in the packet tx info with the most recent | |
3435 | * rate selection table for the station entry. | |
3436 | * | |
3437 | * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. | |
3438 | * @sta: the receiver station to which this packet is sent. | |
3439 | * @skb: the frame to be transmitted. | |
3440 | * @dest: buffer for extracted rate/retry information | |
3441 | * @max_rates: maximum number of rates to fetch | |
3442 | */ | |
3443 | void ieee80211_get_tx_rates(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, | |
3444 | struct ieee80211_sta *sta, | |
3445 | struct sk_buff *skb, | |
3446 | struct ieee80211_tx_rate *dest, | |
3447 | int max_rates); | |
3448 | ||
75a5f0cc JB |
3449 | /** |
3450 | * ieee80211_tx_status - transmit status callback | |
3451 | * | |
3452 | * Call this function for all transmitted frames after they have been | |
3453 | * transmitted. It is permissible to not call this function for | |
3454 | * multicast frames but this can affect statistics. | |
3455 | * | |
2485f710 JB |
3456 | * This function may not be called in IRQ context. Calls to this function |
3457 | * for a single hardware must be synchronized against each other. Calls | |
20ed3166 | 3458 | * to this function, ieee80211_tx_status_ni() and ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe() |
f6b3d85f FF |
3459 | * may not be mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with |
3460 | * ieee80211_rx() or ieee80211_rx_ni(). | |
2485f710 | 3461 | * |
75a5f0cc JB |
3462 | * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by |
3463 | * @skb: the frame that was transmitted, owned by mac80211 after this call | |
75a5f0cc | 3464 | */ |
f0706e82 | 3465 | void ieee80211_tx_status(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, |
e039fa4a | 3466 | struct sk_buff *skb); |
2485f710 | 3467 | |
20ed3166 JS |
3468 | /** |
3469 | * ieee80211_tx_status_ni - transmit status callback (in process context) | |
3470 | * | |
3471 | * Like ieee80211_tx_status() but can be called in process context. | |
3472 | * | |
3473 | * Calls to this function, ieee80211_tx_status() and | |
3474 | * ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe() may not be mixed | |
3475 | * for a single hardware. | |
3476 | * | |
3477 | * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by | |
3478 | * @skb: the frame that was transmitted, owned by mac80211 after this call | |
3479 | */ | |
3480 | static inline void ieee80211_tx_status_ni(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, | |
3481 | struct sk_buff *skb) | |
3482 | { | |
3483 | local_bh_disable(); | |
3484 | ieee80211_tx_status(hw, skb); | |
3485 | local_bh_enable(); | |
3486 | } | |
3487 | ||
2485f710 | 3488 | /** |
6ef307bc | 3489 | * ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe - IRQ-safe transmit status callback |
2485f710 JB |
3490 | * |
3491 | * Like ieee80211_tx_status() but can be called in IRQ context | |
3492 | * (internally defers to a tasklet.) | |
3493 | * | |
20ed3166 JS |
3494 | * Calls to this function, ieee80211_tx_status() and |
3495 | * ieee80211_tx_status_ni() may not be mixed for a single hardware. | |
2485f710 JB |
3496 | * |
3497 | * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by | |
3498 | * @skb: the frame that was transmitted, owned by mac80211 after this call | |
2485f710 | 3499 | */ |
f0706e82 | 3500 | void ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, |
e039fa4a | 3501 | struct sk_buff *skb); |
f0706e82 | 3502 | |
8178d38b AN |
3503 | /** |
3504 | * ieee80211_report_low_ack - report non-responding station | |
3505 | * | |
3506 | * When operating in AP-mode, call this function to report a non-responding | |
3507 | * connected STA. | |
3508 | * | |
3509 | * @sta: the non-responding connected sta | |
3510 | * @num_packets: number of packets sent to @sta without a response | |
3511 | */ | |
3512 | void ieee80211_report_low_ack(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u32 num_packets); | |
3513 | ||
1af586c9 AO |
3514 | #define IEEE80211_MAX_CSA_COUNTERS_NUM 2 |
3515 | ||
6ec8c332 AO |
3516 | /** |
3517 | * struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets - mutable beacon offsets | |
3518 | * @tim_offset: position of TIM element | |
3519 | * @tim_length: size of TIM element | |
8d77ec85 LC |
3520 | * @csa_counter_offs: array of IEEE80211_MAX_CSA_COUNTERS_NUM offsets |
3521 | * to CSA counters. This array can contain zero values which | |
3522 | * should be ignored. | |
6ec8c332 AO |
3523 | */ |
3524 | struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets { | |
3525 | u16 tim_offset; | |
3526 | u16 tim_length; | |
1af586c9 AO |
3527 | |
3528 | u16 csa_counter_offs[IEEE80211_MAX_CSA_COUNTERS_NUM]; | |
6ec8c332 AO |
3529 | }; |
3530 | ||
3531 | /** | |
3532 | * ieee80211_beacon_get_template - beacon template generation function | |
3533 | * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw(). | |
3534 | * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. | |
3535 | * @offs: &struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets pointer to struct that will | |
3536 | * receive the offsets that may be updated by the driver. | |
3537 | * | |
3538 | * If the driver implements beaconing modes, it must use this function to | |
3539 | * obtain the beacon template. | |
3540 | * | |
3541 | * This function should be used if the beacon frames are generated by the | |
3542 | * device, and then the driver must use the returned beacon as the template | |
1af586c9 AO |
3543 | * The driver or the device are responsible to update the DTIM and, when |
3544 | * applicable, the CSA count. | |
6ec8c332 AO |
3545 | * |
3546 | * The driver is responsible for freeing the returned skb. | |
3547 | * | |
3548 | * Return: The beacon template. %NULL on error. | |
3549 | */ | |
3550 | struct sk_buff * | |
3551 | ieee80211_beacon_get_template(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, | |
3552 | struct ieee80211_vif *vif, | |
3553 | struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets *offs); | |
3554 | ||
f0706e82 | 3555 | /** |
eddcbb94 | 3556 | * ieee80211_beacon_get_tim - beacon generation function |
f0706e82 | 3557 | * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw(). |
1ed32e4f | 3558 | * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. |
eddcbb94 JB |
3559 | * @tim_offset: pointer to variable that will receive the TIM IE offset. |
3560 | * Set to 0 if invalid (in non-AP modes). | |
3561 | * @tim_length: pointer to variable that will receive the TIM IE length, | |
3562 | * (including the ID and length bytes!). | |
3563 | * Set to 0 if invalid (in non-AP modes). | |
3564 | * | |
3565 | * If the driver implements beaconing modes, it must use this function to | |
6ec8c332 | 3566 | * obtain the beacon frame. |
f0706e82 JB |
3567 | * |
3568 | * If the beacon frames are generated by the host system (i.e., not in | |
eddcbb94 | 3569 | * hardware/firmware), the driver uses this function to get each beacon |
6ec8c332 AO |
3570 | * frame from mac80211 -- it is responsible for calling this function exactly |
3571 | * once before the beacon is needed (e.g. based on hardware interrupt). | |
eddcbb94 JB |
3572 | * |
3573 | * The driver is responsible for freeing the returned skb. | |
0ae997dc YB |
3574 | * |
3575 | * Return: The beacon template. %NULL on error. | |
eddcbb94 JB |
3576 | */ |
3577 | struct sk_buff *ieee80211_beacon_get_tim(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, | |
3578 | struct ieee80211_vif *vif, | |
3579 | u16 *tim_offset, u16 *tim_length); | |
3580 | ||
3581 | /** | |
3582 | * ieee80211_beacon_get - beacon generation function | |
3583 | * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw(). | |
1ed32e4f | 3584 | * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. |
eddcbb94 JB |
3585 | * |
3586 | * See ieee80211_beacon_get_tim(). | |
0ae997dc YB |
3587 | * |
3588 | * Return: See ieee80211_beacon_get_tim(). | |
f0706e82 | 3589 | */ |
eddcbb94 JB |
3590 | static inline struct sk_buff *ieee80211_beacon_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, |
3591 | struct ieee80211_vif *vif) | |
3592 | { | |
3593 | return ieee80211_beacon_get_tim(hw, vif, NULL, NULL); | |
3594 | } | |
f0706e82 | 3595 | |
1af586c9 AO |
3596 | /** |
3597 | * ieee80211_csa_update_counter - request mac80211 to decrement the csa counter | |
3598 | * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. | |
3599 | * | |
3600 | * The csa counter should be updated after each beacon transmission. | |
3601 | * This function is called implicitly when | |
3602 | * ieee80211_beacon_get/ieee80211_beacon_get_tim are called, however if the | |
3603 | * beacon frames are generated by the device, the driver should call this | |
3604 | * function after each beacon transmission to sync mac80211's csa counters. | |
3605 | * | |
3606 | * Return: new csa counter value | |
3607 | */ | |
3608 | u8 ieee80211_csa_update_counter(struct ieee80211_vif *vif); | |
3609 | ||
73da7d5b SW |
3610 | /** |
3611 | * ieee80211_csa_finish - notify mac80211 about channel switch | |
3612 | * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. | |
3613 | * | |
3614 | * After a channel switch announcement was scheduled and the counter in this | |
66e01cf9 | 3615 | * announcement hits 1, this function must be called by the driver to |
73da7d5b SW |
3616 | * notify mac80211 that the channel can be changed. |
3617 | */ | |
3618 | void ieee80211_csa_finish(struct ieee80211_vif *vif); | |
3619 | ||
3620 | /** | |
66e01cf9 | 3621 | * ieee80211_csa_is_complete - find out if counters reached 1 |
73da7d5b SW |
3622 | * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. |
3623 | * | |
3624 | * This function returns whether the channel switch counters reached zero. | |
3625 | */ | |
3626 | bool ieee80211_csa_is_complete(struct ieee80211_vif *vif); | |
3627 | ||
3628 | ||
02945821 AN |
3629 | /** |
3630 | * ieee80211_proberesp_get - retrieve a Probe Response template | |
3631 | * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw(). | |
3632 | * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. | |
3633 | * | |
3634 | * Creates a Probe Response template which can, for example, be uploaded to | |
3635 | * hardware. The destination address should be set by the caller. | |
3636 | * | |
3637 | * Can only be called in AP mode. | |
0ae997dc YB |
3638 | * |
3639 | * Return: The Probe Response template. %NULL on error. | |
02945821 AN |
3640 | */ |
3641 | struct sk_buff *ieee80211_proberesp_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, | |
3642 | struct ieee80211_vif *vif); | |
3643 | ||
7044cc56 KV |
3644 | /** |
3645 | * ieee80211_pspoll_get - retrieve a PS Poll template | |
3646 | * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw(). | |
3647 | * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. | |
3648 | * | |
3649 | * Creates a PS Poll a template which can, for example, uploaded to | |
3650 | * hardware. The template must be updated after association so that correct | |
3651 | * AID, BSSID and MAC address is used. | |
3652 | * | |
3653 | * Note: Caller (or hardware) is responsible for setting the | |
3654 | * &IEEE80211_FCTL_PM bit. | |
0ae997dc YB |
3655 | * |
3656 | * Return: The PS Poll template. %NULL on error. | |
7044cc56 KV |
3657 | */ |
3658 | struct sk_buff *ieee80211_pspoll_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, | |
3659 | struct ieee80211_vif *vif); | |
3660 | ||
3661 | /** | |
3662 | * ieee80211_nullfunc_get - retrieve a nullfunc template | |
3663 | * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw(). | |
3664 | * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. | |
3665 | * | |
3666 | * Creates a Nullfunc template which can, for example, uploaded to | |
3667 | * hardware. The template must be updated after association so that correct | |
3668 | * BSSID and address is used. | |
3669 | * | |
3670 | * Note: Caller (or hardware) is responsible for setting the | |
3671 | * &IEEE80211_FCTL_PM bit as well as Duration and Sequence Control fields. | |
0ae997dc YB |
3672 | * |
3673 | * Return: The nullfunc template. %NULL on error. | |
7044cc56 KV |
3674 | */ |
3675 | struct sk_buff *ieee80211_nullfunc_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, | |
3676 | struct ieee80211_vif *vif); | |
3677 | ||
05e54ea6 KV |
3678 | /** |
3679 | * ieee80211_probereq_get - retrieve a Probe Request template | |
3680 | * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw(). | |
3681 | * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. | |
3682 | * @ssid: SSID buffer | |
3683 | * @ssid_len: length of SSID | |
b9a9ada1 | 3684 | * @tailroom: tailroom to reserve at end of SKB for IEs |
05e54ea6 KV |
3685 | * |
3686 | * Creates a Probe Request template which can, for example, be uploaded to | |
3687 | * hardware. | |
0ae997dc YB |
3688 | * |
3689 | * Return: The Probe Request template. %NULL on error. | |
05e54ea6 KV |
3690 | */ |
3691 | struct sk_buff *ieee80211_probereq_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, | |
3692 | struct ieee80211_vif *vif, | |
3693 | const u8 *ssid, size_t ssid_len, | |
b9a9ada1 | 3694 | size_t tailroom); |
05e54ea6 | 3695 | |
f0706e82 JB |
3696 | /** |
3697 | * ieee80211_rts_get - RTS frame generation function | |
3698 | * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw(). | |
1ed32e4f | 3699 | * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. |
f0706e82 JB |
3700 | * @frame: pointer to the frame that is going to be protected by the RTS. |
3701 | * @frame_len: the frame length (in octets). | |
e039fa4a | 3702 | * @frame_txctl: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame. |
f0706e82 JB |
3703 | * @rts: The buffer where to store the RTS frame. |
3704 | * | |
3705 | * If the RTS frames are generated by the host system (i.e., not in | |
3706 | * hardware/firmware), the low-level driver uses this function to receive | |
3707 | * the next RTS frame from the 802.11 code. The low-level is responsible | |
3708 | * for calling this function before and RTS frame is needed. | |
3709 | */ | |
32bfd35d | 3710 | void ieee80211_rts_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif, |
f0706e82 | 3711 | const void *frame, size_t frame_len, |
e039fa4a | 3712 | const struct ieee80211_tx_info *frame_txctl, |
f0706e82 JB |
3713 | struct ieee80211_rts *rts); |
3714 | ||
3715 | /** | |
3716 | * ieee80211_rts_duration - Get the duration field for an RTS frame | |
3717 | * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw(). | |
1ed32e4f | 3718 | * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. |
f0706e82 | 3719 | * @frame_len: the length of the frame that is going to be protected by the RTS. |
e039fa4a | 3720 | * @frame_txctl: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame. |
f0706e82 JB |
3721 | * |
3722 | * If the RTS is generated in firmware, but the host system must provide | |
3723 | * the duration field, the low-level driver uses this function to receive | |
3724 | * the duration field value in little-endian byteorder. | |
0ae997dc YB |
3725 | * |
3726 | * Return: The duration. | |
f0706e82 | 3727 | */ |
32bfd35d JB |
3728 | __le16 ieee80211_rts_duration(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, |
3729 | struct ieee80211_vif *vif, size_t frame_len, | |
e039fa4a | 3730 | const struct ieee80211_tx_info *frame_txctl); |
f0706e82 JB |
3731 | |
3732 | /** | |
3733 | * ieee80211_ctstoself_get - CTS-to-self frame generation function | |
3734 | * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw(). | |
1ed32e4f | 3735 | * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. |
f0706e82 JB |
3736 | * @frame: pointer to the frame that is going to be protected by the CTS-to-self. |
3737 | * @frame_len: the frame length (in octets). | |
e039fa4a | 3738 | * @frame_txctl: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame. |
f0706e82 JB |
3739 | * @cts: The buffer where to store the CTS-to-self frame. |
3740 | * | |
3741 | * If the CTS-to-self frames are generated by the host system (i.e., not in | |
3742 | * hardware/firmware), the low-level driver uses this function to receive | |
3743 | * the next CTS-to-self frame from the 802.11 code. The low-level is responsible | |
3744 | * for calling this function before and CTS-to-self frame is needed. | |
3745 | */ | |
32bfd35d JB |
3746 | void ieee80211_ctstoself_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, |
3747 | struct ieee80211_vif *vif, | |
f0706e82 | 3748 | const void *frame, size_t frame_len, |
e039fa4a | 3749 | const struct ieee80211_tx_info *frame_txctl, |
f0706e82 JB |
3750 | struct ieee80211_cts *cts); |
3751 | ||
3752 | /** | |
3753 | * ieee80211_ctstoself_duration - Get the duration field for a CTS-to-self frame | |
3754 | * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw(). | |
1ed32e4f | 3755 | * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. |
f0706e82 | 3756 | * @frame_len: the length of the frame that is going to be protected by the CTS-to-self. |
e039fa4a | 3757 | * @frame_txctl: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame. |
f0706e82 JB |
3758 | * |
3759 | * If the CTS-to-self is generated in firmware, but the host system must provide | |
3760 | * the duration field, the low-level driver uses this function to receive | |
3761 | * the duration field value in little-endian byteorder. | |
0ae997dc YB |
3762 | * |
3763 | * Return: The duration. | |
f0706e82 | 3764 | */ |
32bfd35d JB |
3765 | __le16 ieee80211_ctstoself_duration(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, |
3766 | struct ieee80211_vif *vif, | |
f0706e82 | 3767 | size_t frame_len, |
e039fa4a | 3768 | const struct ieee80211_tx_info *frame_txctl); |
f0706e82 JB |
3769 | |
3770 | /** | |
3771 | * ieee80211_generic_frame_duration - Calculate the duration field for a frame | |
3772 | * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw(). | |
1ed32e4f | 3773 | * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. |
d13e1414 | 3774 | * @band: the band to calculate the frame duration on |
f0706e82 | 3775 | * @frame_len: the length of the frame. |
8318d78a | 3776 | * @rate: the rate at which the frame is going to be transmitted. |
f0706e82 JB |
3777 | * |
3778 | * Calculate the duration field of some generic frame, given its | |
3779 | * length and transmission rate (in 100kbps). | |
0ae997dc YB |
3780 | * |
3781 | * Return: The duration. | |
f0706e82 | 3782 | */ |
32bfd35d JB |
3783 | __le16 ieee80211_generic_frame_duration(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, |
3784 | struct ieee80211_vif *vif, | |
4ee73f33 | 3785 | enum ieee80211_band band, |
f0706e82 | 3786 | size_t frame_len, |
8318d78a | 3787 | struct ieee80211_rate *rate); |
f0706e82 JB |
3788 | |
3789 | /** | |
3790 | * ieee80211_get_buffered_bc - accessing buffered broadcast and multicast frames | |
3791 | * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw(). | |
1ed32e4f | 3792 | * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. |
f0706e82 JB |
3793 | * |
3794 | * Function for accessing buffered broadcast and multicast frames. If | |
3795 | * hardware/firmware does not implement buffering of broadcast/multicast | |
3796 | * frames when power saving is used, 802.11 code buffers them in the host | |
3797 | * memory. The low-level driver uses this function to fetch next buffered | |
0ae997dc YB |
3798 | * frame. In most cases, this is used when generating beacon frame. |
3799 | * | |
3800 | * Return: A pointer to the next buffered skb or NULL if no more buffered | |
3801 | * frames are available. | |
f0706e82 JB |
3802 | * |
3803 | * Note: buffered frames are returned only after DTIM beacon frame was | |
3804 | * generated with ieee80211_beacon_get() and the low-level driver must thus | |
3805 | * call ieee80211_beacon_get() first. ieee80211_get_buffered_bc() returns | |
3806 | * NULL if the previous generated beacon was not DTIM, so the low-level driver | |
3807 | * does not need to check for DTIM beacons separately and should be able to | |
3808 | * use common code for all beacons. | |
3809 | */ | |
3810 | struct sk_buff * | |
e039fa4a | 3811 | ieee80211_get_buffered_bc(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif); |
f0706e82 | 3812 | |
42d98795 JB |
3813 | /** |
3814 | * ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k_iv - get a TKIP phase 1 key for IV32 | |
3815 | * | |
3816 | * This function returns the TKIP phase 1 key for the given IV32. | |
3817 | * | |
3818 | * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key | |
3819 | * @iv32: IV32 to get the P1K for | |
3820 | * @p1k: a buffer to which the key will be written, as 5 u16 values | |
3821 | */ | |
3822 | void ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k_iv(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf, | |
3823 | u32 iv32, u16 *p1k); | |
3824 | ||
5d2cdcd4 | 3825 | /** |
523b02ea JB |
3826 | * ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k - get a TKIP phase 1 key |
3827 | * | |
3828 | * This function returns the TKIP phase 1 key for the IV32 taken | |
3829 | * from the given packet. | |
3830 | * | |
3831 | * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key | |
3832 | * @skb: the packet to take the IV32 value from that will be encrypted | |
3833 | * with this P1K | |
3834 | * @p1k: a buffer to which the key will be written, as 5 u16 values | |
3835 | */ | |
42d98795 JB |
3836 | static inline void ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf, |
3837 | struct sk_buff *skb, u16 *p1k) | |
3838 | { | |
3839 | struct ieee80211_hdr *hdr = (struct ieee80211_hdr *)skb->data; | |
3840 | const u8 *data = (u8 *)hdr + ieee80211_hdrlen(hdr->frame_control); | |
3841 | u32 iv32 = get_unaligned_le32(&data[4]); | |
3842 | ||
3843 | ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k_iv(keyconf, iv32, p1k); | |
3844 | } | |
523b02ea | 3845 | |
8bca5d81 JB |
3846 | /** |
3847 | * ieee80211_get_tkip_rx_p1k - get a TKIP phase 1 key for RX | |
3848 | * | |
3849 | * This function returns the TKIP phase 1 key for the given IV32 | |
3850 | * and transmitter address. | |
3851 | * | |
3852 | * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key | |
3853 | * @ta: TA that will be used with the key | |
3854 | * @iv32: IV32 to get the P1K for | |
3855 | * @p1k: a buffer to which the key will be written, as 5 u16 values | |
3856 | */ | |
3857 | void ieee80211_get_tkip_rx_p1k(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf, | |
3858 | const u8 *ta, u32 iv32, u16 *p1k); | |
3859 | ||
523b02ea JB |
3860 | /** |
3861 | * ieee80211_get_tkip_p2k - get a TKIP phase 2 key | |
5d2cdcd4 | 3862 | * |
523b02ea JB |
3863 | * This function computes the TKIP RC4 key for the IV values |
3864 | * in the packet. | |
5d2cdcd4 EG |
3865 | * |
3866 | * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key | |
523b02ea JB |
3867 | * @skb: the packet to take the IV32/IV16 values from that will be |
3868 | * encrypted with this key | |
3869 | * @p2k: a buffer to which the key will be written, 16 bytes | |
5d2cdcd4 | 3870 | */ |
523b02ea JB |
3871 | void ieee80211_get_tkip_p2k(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf, |
3872 | struct sk_buff *skb, u8 *p2k); | |
c68f4b89 | 3873 | |
5d0d04e4 AK |
3874 | /** |
3875 | * ieee80211_aes_cmac_calculate_k1_k2 - calculate the AES-CMAC sub keys | |
3876 | * | |
3877 | * This function computes the two AES-CMAC sub-keys, based on the | |
3878 | * previously installed master key. | |
3879 | * | |
3880 | * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key | |
3881 | * @k1: a buffer to be filled with the 1st sub-key | |
3882 | * @k2: a buffer to be filled with the 2nd sub-key | |
3883 | */ | |
3884 | void ieee80211_aes_cmac_calculate_k1_k2(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf, | |
3885 | u8 *k1, u8 *k2); | |
3886 | ||
3ea542d3 JB |
3887 | /** |
3888 | * struct ieee80211_key_seq - key sequence counter | |
3889 | * | |
3890 | * @tkip: TKIP data, containing IV32 and IV16 in host byte order | |
3891 | * @ccmp: PN data, most significant byte first (big endian, | |
3892 | * reverse order than in packet) | |
3893 | * @aes_cmac: PN data, most significant byte first (big endian, | |
3894 | * reverse order than in packet) | |
3895 | */ | |
3896 | struct ieee80211_key_seq { | |
3897 | union { | |
3898 | struct { | |
3899 | u32 iv32; | |
3900 | u16 iv16; | |
3901 | } tkip; | |
3902 | struct { | |
3903 | u8 pn[6]; | |
3904 | } ccmp; | |
3905 | struct { | |
3906 | u8 pn[6]; | |
3907 | } aes_cmac; | |
3908 | }; | |
3909 | }; | |
3910 | ||
3911 | /** | |
3912 | * ieee80211_get_key_tx_seq - get key TX sequence counter | |
3913 | * | |
3914 | * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key | |
3915 | * @seq: buffer to receive the sequence data | |
3916 | * | |
3917 | * This function allows a driver to retrieve the current TX IV/PN | |
3918 | * for the given key. It must not be called if IV generation is | |
3919 | * offloaded to the device. | |
3920 | * | |
3921 | * Note that this function may only be called when no TX processing | |
3922 | * can be done concurrently, for example when queues are stopped | |
3923 | * and the stop has been synchronized. | |
3924 | */ | |
3925 | void ieee80211_get_key_tx_seq(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf, | |
3926 | struct ieee80211_key_seq *seq); | |
3927 | ||
3928 | /** | |
3929 | * ieee80211_get_key_rx_seq - get key RX sequence counter | |
3930 | * | |
3931 | * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key | |
3932 | * @tid: The TID, or -1 for the management frame value (CCMP only); | |
3933 | * the value on TID 0 is also used for non-QoS frames. For | |
3934 | * CMAC, only TID 0 is valid. | |
3935 | * @seq: buffer to receive the sequence data | |
3936 | * | |
3937 | * This function allows a driver to retrieve the current RX IV/PNs | |
3938 | * for the given key. It must not be called if IV checking is done | |
3939 | * by the device and not by mac80211. | |
3940 | * | |
3941 | * Note that this function may only be called when no RX processing | |
3942 | * can be done concurrently. | |
3943 | */ | |
3944 | void ieee80211_get_key_rx_seq(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf, | |
3945 | int tid, struct ieee80211_key_seq *seq); | |
3946 | ||
27b3eb9c JB |
3947 | /** |
3948 | * ieee80211_set_key_tx_seq - set key TX sequence counter | |
3949 | * | |
3950 | * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key | |
3951 | * @seq: new sequence data | |
3952 | * | |
3953 | * This function allows a driver to set the current TX IV/PNs for the | |
3954 | * given key. This is useful when resuming from WoWLAN sleep and the | |
3955 | * device may have transmitted frames using the PTK, e.g. replies to | |
3956 | * ARP requests. | |
3957 | * | |
3958 | * Note that this function may only be called when no TX processing | |
3959 | * can be done concurrently. | |
3960 | */ | |
3961 | void ieee80211_set_key_tx_seq(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf, | |
3962 | struct ieee80211_key_seq *seq); | |
3963 | ||
3964 | /** | |
3965 | * ieee80211_set_key_rx_seq - set key RX sequence counter | |
3966 | * | |
3967 | * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key | |
3968 | * @tid: The TID, or -1 for the management frame value (CCMP only); | |
3969 | * the value on TID 0 is also used for non-QoS frames. For | |
3970 | * CMAC, only TID 0 is valid. | |
3971 | * @seq: new sequence data | |
3972 | * | |
3973 | * This function allows a driver to set the current RX IV/PNs for the | |
3974 | * given key. This is useful when resuming from WoWLAN sleep and GTK | |
3975 | * rekey may have been done while suspended. It should not be called | |
3976 | * if IV checking is done by the device and not by mac80211. | |
3977 | * | |
3978 | * Note that this function may only be called when no RX processing | |
3979 | * can be done concurrently. | |
3980 | */ | |
3981 | void ieee80211_set_key_rx_seq(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf, | |
3982 | int tid, struct ieee80211_key_seq *seq); | |
3983 | ||
3984 | /** | |
3985 | * ieee80211_remove_key - remove the given key | |
3986 | * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key | |
3987 | * | |
3988 | * Remove the given key. If the key was uploaded to the hardware at the | |
3989 | * time this function is called, it is not deleted in the hardware but | |
3990 | * instead assumed to have been removed already. | |
3991 | * | |
3992 | * Note that due to locking considerations this function can (currently) | |
3993 | * only be called during key iteration (ieee80211_iter_keys().) | |
3994 | */ | |
3995 | void ieee80211_remove_key(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf); | |
3996 | ||
3997 | /** | |
3998 | * ieee80211_gtk_rekey_add - add a GTK key from rekeying during WoWLAN | |
3999 | * @vif: the virtual interface to add the key on | |
4000 | * @keyconf: new key data | |
4001 | * | |
4002 | * When GTK rekeying was done while the system was suspended, (a) new | |
4003 | * key(s) will be available. These will be needed by mac80211 for proper | |
4004 | * RX processing, so this function allows setting them. | |
4005 | * | |
4006 | * The function returns the newly allocated key structure, which will | |
4007 | * have similar contents to the passed key configuration but point to | |
4008 | * mac80211-owned memory. In case of errors, the function returns an | |
4009 | * ERR_PTR(), use IS_ERR() etc. | |
4010 | * | |
4011 | * Note that this function assumes the key isn't added to hardware | |
4012 | * acceleration, so no TX will be done with the key. Since it's a GTK | |
4013 | * on managed (station) networks, this is true anyway. If the driver | |
4014 | * calls this function from the resume callback and subsequently uses | |
4015 | * the return code 1 to reconfigure the device, this key will be part | |
4016 | * of the reconfiguration. | |
4017 | * | |
4018 | * Note that the driver should also call ieee80211_set_key_rx_seq() | |
4019 | * for the new key for each TID to set up sequence counters properly. | |
4020 | * | |
4021 | * IMPORTANT: If this replaces a key that is present in the hardware, | |
4022 | * then it will attempt to remove it during this call. In many cases | |
4023 | * this isn't what you want, so call ieee80211_remove_key() first for | |
4024 | * the key that's being replaced. | |
4025 | */ | |
4026 | struct ieee80211_key_conf * | |
4027 | ieee80211_gtk_rekey_add(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, | |
4028 | struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf); | |
4029 | ||
c68f4b89 JB |
4030 | /** |
4031 | * ieee80211_gtk_rekey_notify - notify userspace supplicant of rekeying | |
4032 | * @vif: virtual interface the rekeying was done on | |
4033 | * @bssid: The BSSID of the AP, for checking association | |
4034 | * @replay_ctr: the new replay counter after GTK rekeying | |
4035 | * @gfp: allocation flags | |
4036 | */ | |
4037 | void ieee80211_gtk_rekey_notify(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *bssid, | |
4038 | const u8 *replay_ctr, gfp_t gfp); | |
4039 | ||
f0706e82 JB |
4040 | /** |
4041 | * ieee80211_wake_queue - wake specific queue | |
4042 | * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw(). | |
4043 | * @queue: queue number (counted from zero). | |
4044 | * | |
4045 | * Drivers should use this function instead of netif_wake_queue. | |
4046 | */ | |
4047 | void ieee80211_wake_queue(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int queue); | |
4048 | ||
4049 | /** | |
4050 | * ieee80211_stop_queue - stop specific queue | |
4051 | * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw(). | |
4052 | * @queue: queue number (counted from zero). | |
4053 | * | |
4054 | * Drivers should use this function instead of netif_stop_queue. | |
4055 | */ | |
4056 | void ieee80211_stop_queue(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int queue); | |
4057 | ||
92ab8535 TW |
4058 | /** |
4059 | * ieee80211_queue_stopped - test status of the queue | |
4060 | * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw(). | |
4061 | * @queue: queue number (counted from zero). | |
4062 | * | |
4063 | * Drivers should use this function instead of netif_stop_queue. | |
0ae997dc YB |
4064 | * |
4065 | * Return: %true if the queue is stopped. %false otherwise. | |
92ab8535 TW |
4066 | */ |
4067 | ||
4068 | int ieee80211_queue_stopped(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int queue); | |
4069 | ||
f0706e82 JB |
4070 | /** |
4071 | * ieee80211_stop_queues - stop all queues | |
4072 | * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw(). | |
4073 | * | |
4074 | * Drivers should use this function instead of netif_stop_queue. | |
4075 | */ | |
4076 | void ieee80211_stop_queues(struct ieee80211_hw *hw); | |
4077 | ||
4078 | /** | |
4079 | * ieee80211_wake_queues - wake all queues | |
4080 | * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw(). | |
4081 | * | |
4082 | * Drivers should use this function instead of netif_wake_queue. | |
4083 | */ | |
4084 | void ieee80211_wake_queues(struct ieee80211_hw *hw); | |
4085 | ||
75a5f0cc JB |
4086 | /** |
4087 | * ieee80211_scan_completed - completed hardware scan | |
4088 | * | |
4089 | * When hardware scan offload is used (i.e. the hw_scan() callback is | |
4090 | * assigned) this function needs to be called by the driver to notify | |
8789d459 JB |
4091 | * mac80211 that the scan finished. This function can be called from |
4092 | * any context, including hardirq context. | |
75a5f0cc JB |
4093 | * |
4094 | * @hw: the hardware that finished the scan | |
2a519311 | 4095 | * @aborted: set to true if scan was aborted |
75a5f0cc | 4096 | */ |
2a519311 | 4097 | void ieee80211_scan_completed(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, bool aborted); |
f0706e82 | 4098 | |
79f460ca LC |
4099 | /** |
4100 | * ieee80211_sched_scan_results - got results from scheduled scan | |
4101 | * | |
4102 | * When a scheduled scan is running, this function needs to be called by the | |
4103 | * driver whenever there are new scan results available. | |
4104 | * | |
4105 | * @hw: the hardware that is performing scheduled scans | |
4106 | */ | |
4107 | void ieee80211_sched_scan_results(struct ieee80211_hw *hw); | |
4108 | ||
4109 | /** | |
4110 | * ieee80211_sched_scan_stopped - inform that the scheduled scan has stopped | |
4111 | * | |
4112 | * When a scheduled scan is running, this function can be called by | |
4113 | * the driver if it needs to stop the scan to perform another task. | |
4114 | * Usual scenarios are drivers that cannot continue the scheduled scan | |
4115 | * while associating, for instance. | |
4116 | * | |
4117 | * @hw: the hardware that is performing scheduled scans | |
4118 | */ | |
4119 | void ieee80211_sched_scan_stopped(struct ieee80211_hw *hw); | |
4120 | ||
8b2c9824 JB |
4121 | /** |
4122 | * enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags - interface iteration flags | |
4123 | * @IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_NORMAL: Iterate over all interfaces that have | |
4124 | * been added to the driver; However, note that during hardware | |
4125 | * reconfiguration (after restart_hw) it will iterate over a new | |
4126 | * interface and over all the existing interfaces even if they | |
4127 | * haven't been re-added to the driver yet. | |
4128 | * @IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_RESUME_ALL: During resume, iterate over all | |
4129 | * interfaces, even if they haven't been re-added to the driver yet. | |
4130 | */ | |
4131 | enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags { | |
4132 | IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_NORMAL = 0, | |
4133 | IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_RESUME_ALL = BIT(0), | |
4134 | }; | |
4135 | ||
dabeb344 | 4136 | /** |
6ef307bc | 4137 | * ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces - iterate active interfaces |
dabeb344 JB |
4138 | * |
4139 | * This function iterates over the interfaces associated with a given | |
4140 | * hardware that are currently active and calls the callback for them. | |
2f561feb ID |
4141 | * This function allows the iterator function to sleep, when the iterator |
4142 | * function is atomic @ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_atomic can | |
4143 | * be used. | |
8b2c9824 | 4144 | * Does not iterate over a new interface during add_interface(). |
dabeb344 JB |
4145 | * |
4146 | * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over | |
8b2c9824 | 4147 | * @iter_flags: iteration flags, see &enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags |
2f561feb | 4148 | * @iterator: the iterator function to call |
dabeb344 JB |
4149 | * @data: first argument of the iterator function |
4150 | */ | |
4151 | void ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, | |
8b2c9824 | 4152 | u32 iter_flags, |
dabeb344 | 4153 | void (*iterator)(void *data, u8 *mac, |
32bfd35d | 4154 | struct ieee80211_vif *vif), |
dabeb344 JB |
4155 | void *data); |
4156 | ||
2f561feb ID |
4157 | /** |
4158 | * ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_atomic - iterate active interfaces | |
4159 | * | |
4160 | * This function iterates over the interfaces associated with a given | |
4161 | * hardware that are currently active and calls the callback for them. | |
4162 | * This function requires the iterator callback function to be atomic, | |
4163 | * if that is not desired, use @ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces instead. | |
8b2c9824 | 4164 | * Does not iterate over a new interface during add_interface(). |
2f561feb ID |
4165 | * |
4166 | * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over | |
8b2c9824 | 4167 | * @iter_flags: iteration flags, see &enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags |
2f561feb ID |
4168 | * @iterator: the iterator function to call, cannot sleep |
4169 | * @data: first argument of the iterator function | |
4170 | */ | |
4171 | void ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_atomic(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, | |
8b2c9824 | 4172 | u32 iter_flags, |
2f561feb ID |
4173 | void (*iterator)(void *data, |
4174 | u8 *mac, | |
4175 | struct ieee80211_vif *vif), | |
4176 | void *data); | |
4177 | ||
c7c71066 JB |
4178 | /** |
4179 | * ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_rtnl - iterate active interfaces | |
4180 | * | |
4181 | * This function iterates over the interfaces associated with a given | |
4182 | * hardware that are currently active and calls the callback for them. | |
4183 | * This version can only be used while holding the RTNL. | |
4184 | * | |
4185 | * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over | |
4186 | * @iter_flags: iteration flags, see &enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags | |
4187 | * @iterator: the iterator function to call, cannot sleep | |
4188 | * @data: first argument of the iterator function | |
4189 | */ | |
4190 | void ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_rtnl(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, | |
4191 | u32 iter_flags, | |
4192 | void (*iterator)(void *data, | |
4193 | u8 *mac, | |
4194 | struct ieee80211_vif *vif), | |
4195 | void *data); | |
4196 | ||
42935eca LR |
4197 | /** |
4198 | * ieee80211_queue_work - add work onto the mac80211 workqueue | |
4199 | * | |
4200 | * Drivers and mac80211 use this to add work onto the mac80211 workqueue. | |
4201 | * This helper ensures drivers are not queueing work when they should not be. | |
4202 | * | |
4203 | * @hw: the hardware struct for the interface we are adding work for | |
4204 | * @work: the work we want to add onto the mac80211 workqueue | |
4205 | */ | |
4206 | void ieee80211_queue_work(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct work_struct *work); | |
4207 | ||
4208 | /** | |
4209 | * ieee80211_queue_delayed_work - add work onto the mac80211 workqueue | |
4210 | * | |
4211 | * Drivers and mac80211 use this to queue delayed work onto the mac80211 | |
4212 | * workqueue. | |
4213 | * | |
4214 | * @hw: the hardware struct for the interface we are adding work for | |
4215 | * @dwork: delayable work to queue onto the mac80211 workqueue | |
4216 | * @delay: number of jiffies to wait before queueing | |
4217 | */ | |
4218 | void ieee80211_queue_delayed_work(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, | |
4219 | struct delayed_work *dwork, | |
4220 | unsigned long delay); | |
4221 | ||
0df3ef45 RR |
4222 | /** |
4223 | * ieee80211_start_tx_ba_session - Start a tx Block Ack session. | |
c951ad35 | 4224 | * @sta: the station for which to start a BA session |
0df3ef45 | 4225 | * @tid: the TID to BA on. |
bd2ce6e4 | 4226 | * @timeout: session timeout value (in TUs) |
ea2d8b59 RD |
4227 | * |
4228 | * Return: success if addBA request was sent, failure otherwise | |
0df3ef45 RR |
4229 | * |
4230 | * Although mac80211/low level driver/user space application can estimate | |
4231 | * the need to start aggregation on a certain RA/TID, the session level | |
4232 | * will be managed by the mac80211. | |
4233 | */ | |
bd2ce6e4 SM |
4234 | int ieee80211_start_tx_ba_session(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u16 tid, |
4235 | u16 timeout); | |
0df3ef45 | 4236 | |
0df3ef45 RR |
4237 | /** |
4238 | * ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe - low level driver ready to aggregate. | |
1ed32e4f | 4239 | * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback |
0df3ef45 RR |
4240 | * @ra: receiver address of the BA session recipient. |
4241 | * @tid: the TID to BA on. | |
4242 | * | |
4243 | * This function must be called by low level driver once it has | |
5d22c89b JB |
4244 | * finished with preparations for the BA session. It can be called |
4245 | * from any context. | |
0df3ef45 | 4246 | */ |
c951ad35 | 4247 | void ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *ra, |
0df3ef45 RR |
4248 | u16 tid); |
4249 | ||
4250 | /** | |
4251 | * ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_session - Stop a Block Ack session. | |
c951ad35 | 4252 | * @sta: the station whose BA session to stop |
0df3ef45 | 4253 | * @tid: the TID to stop BA. |
ea2d8b59 | 4254 | * |
6a8579d0 | 4255 | * Return: negative error if the TID is invalid, or no aggregation active |
0df3ef45 RR |
4256 | * |
4257 | * Although mac80211/low level driver/user space application can estimate | |
4258 | * the need to stop aggregation on a certain RA/TID, the session level | |
4259 | * will be managed by the mac80211. | |
4260 | */ | |
6a8579d0 | 4261 | int ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_session(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u16 tid); |
0df3ef45 | 4262 | |
0df3ef45 RR |
4263 | /** |
4264 | * ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe - low level driver ready to stop aggregate. | |
1ed32e4f | 4265 | * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback |
0df3ef45 RR |
4266 | * @ra: receiver address of the BA session recipient. |
4267 | * @tid: the desired TID to BA on. | |
4268 | * | |
4269 | * This function must be called by low level driver once it has | |
5d22c89b JB |
4270 | * finished with preparations for the BA session tear down. It |
4271 | * can be called from any context. | |
0df3ef45 | 4272 | */ |
c951ad35 | 4273 | void ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *ra, |
0df3ef45 RR |
4274 | u16 tid); |
4275 | ||
17741cdc JB |
4276 | /** |
4277 | * ieee80211_find_sta - find a station | |
4278 | * | |
5ed176e1 | 4279 | * @vif: virtual interface to look for station on |
17741cdc JB |
4280 | * @addr: station's address |
4281 | * | |
0ae997dc YB |
4282 | * Return: The station, if found. %NULL otherwise. |
4283 | * | |
4284 | * Note: This function must be called under RCU lock and the | |
17741cdc JB |
4285 | * resulting pointer is only valid under RCU lock as well. |
4286 | */ | |
5ed176e1 | 4287 | struct ieee80211_sta *ieee80211_find_sta(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, |
17741cdc JB |
4288 | const u8 *addr); |
4289 | ||
5ed176e1 | 4290 | /** |
686b9cb9 | 4291 | * ieee80211_find_sta_by_ifaddr - find a station on hardware |
5ed176e1 JB |
4292 | * |
4293 | * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw() | |
686b9cb9 BG |
4294 | * @addr: remote station's address |
4295 | * @localaddr: local address (vif->sdata->vif.addr). Use NULL for 'any'. | |
5ed176e1 | 4296 | * |
0ae997dc YB |
4297 | * Return: The station, if found. %NULL otherwise. |
4298 | * | |
4299 | * Note: This function must be called under RCU lock and the | |
5ed176e1 JB |
4300 | * resulting pointer is only valid under RCU lock as well. |
4301 | * | |
686b9cb9 BG |
4302 | * NOTE: You may pass NULL for localaddr, but then you will just get |
4303 | * the first STA that matches the remote address 'addr'. | |
4304 | * We can have multiple STA associated with multiple | |
4305 | * logical stations (e.g. consider a station connecting to another | |
4306 | * BSSID on the same AP hardware without disconnecting first). | |
4307 | * In this case, the result of this method with localaddr NULL | |
4308 | * is not reliable. | |
5ed176e1 | 4309 | * |
686b9cb9 | 4310 | * DO NOT USE THIS FUNCTION with localaddr NULL if at all possible. |
5ed176e1 | 4311 | */ |
686b9cb9 BG |
4312 | struct ieee80211_sta *ieee80211_find_sta_by_ifaddr(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, |
4313 | const u8 *addr, | |
4314 | const u8 *localaddr); | |
5ed176e1 | 4315 | |
af818581 JB |
4316 | /** |
4317 | * ieee80211_sta_block_awake - block station from waking up | |
4318 | * @hw: the hardware | |
4319 | * @pubsta: the station | |
4320 | * @block: whether to block or unblock | |
4321 | * | |
4322 | * Some devices require that all frames that are on the queues | |
4323 | * for a specific station that went to sleep are flushed before | |
4324 | * a poll response or frames after the station woke up can be | |
4325 | * delivered to that it. Note that such frames must be rejected | |
4326 | * by the driver as filtered, with the appropriate status flag. | |
4327 | * | |
4328 | * This function allows implementing this mode in a race-free | |
4329 | * manner. | |
4330 | * | |
4331 | * To do this, a driver must keep track of the number of frames | |
4332 | * still enqueued for a specific station. If this number is not | |
4333 | * zero when the station goes to sleep, the driver must call | |
4334 | * this function to force mac80211 to consider the station to | |
4335 | * be asleep regardless of the station's actual state. Once the | |
4336 | * number of outstanding frames reaches zero, the driver must | |
4337 | * call this function again to unblock the station. That will | |
4338 | * cause mac80211 to be able to send ps-poll responses, and if | |
4339 | * the station queried in the meantime then frames will also | |
4340 | * be sent out as a result of this. Additionally, the driver | |
4341 | * will be notified that the station woke up some time after | |
4342 | * it is unblocked, regardless of whether the station actually | |
4343 | * woke up while blocked or not. | |
4344 | */ | |
4345 | void ieee80211_sta_block_awake(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, | |
4346 | struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta, bool block); | |
4347 | ||
37fbd908 JB |
4348 | /** |
4349 | * ieee80211_sta_eosp - notify mac80211 about end of SP | |
4350 | * @pubsta: the station | |
4351 | * | |
4352 | * When a device transmits frames in a way that it can't tell | |
4353 | * mac80211 in the TX status about the EOSP, it must clear the | |
4354 | * %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP bit and call this function instead. | |
4355 | * This applies for PS-Poll as well as uAPSD. | |
4356 | * | |
e943789e JB |
4357 | * Note that just like with _tx_status() and _rx() drivers must |
4358 | * not mix calls to irqsafe/non-irqsafe versions, this function | |
4359 | * must not be mixed with those either. Use the all irqsafe, or | |
4360 | * all non-irqsafe, don't mix! | |
4361 | * | |
4362 | * NB: the _irqsafe version of this function doesn't exist, no | |
4363 | * driver needs it right now. Don't call this function if | |
4364 | * you'd need the _irqsafe version, look at the git history | |
4365 | * and restore the _irqsafe version! | |
37fbd908 | 4366 | */ |
e943789e | 4367 | void ieee80211_sta_eosp(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta); |
37fbd908 | 4368 | |
830af02f JB |
4369 | /** |
4370 | * ieee80211_iter_keys - iterate keys programmed into the device | |
4371 | * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw() | |
4372 | * @vif: virtual interface to iterate, may be %NULL for all | |
4373 | * @iter: iterator function that will be called for each key | |
4374 | * @iter_data: custom data to pass to the iterator function | |
4375 | * | |
4376 | * This function can be used to iterate all the keys known to | |
4377 | * mac80211, even those that weren't previously programmed into | |
4378 | * the device. This is intended for use in WoWLAN if the device | |
4379 | * needs reprogramming of the keys during suspend. Note that due | |
4380 | * to locking reasons, it is also only safe to call this at few | |
4381 | * spots since it must hold the RTNL and be able to sleep. | |
f850e00f JB |
4382 | * |
4383 | * The order in which the keys are iterated matches the order | |
4384 | * in which they were originally installed and handed to the | |
4385 | * set_key callback. | |
830af02f JB |
4386 | */ |
4387 | void ieee80211_iter_keys(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, | |
4388 | struct ieee80211_vif *vif, | |
4389 | void (*iter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, | |
4390 | struct ieee80211_vif *vif, | |
4391 | struct ieee80211_sta *sta, | |
4392 | struct ieee80211_key_conf *key, | |
4393 | void *data), | |
4394 | void *iter_data); | |
4395 | ||
3448c005 JB |
4396 | /** |
4397 | * ieee80211_iter_chan_contexts_atomic - iterate channel contexts | |
4398 | * @hw: pointre obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw(). | |
4399 | * @iter: iterator function | |
4400 | * @iter_data: data passed to iterator function | |
4401 | * | |
4402 | * Iterate all active channel contexts. This function is atomic and | |
4403 | * doesn't acquire any locks internally that might be held in other | |
4404 | * places while calling into the driver. | |
4405 | * | |
4406 | * The iterator will not find a context that's being added (during | |
4407 | * the driver callback to add it) but will find it while it's being | |
4408 | * removed. | |
8a61af65 JB |
4409 | * |
4410 | * Note that during hardware restart, all contexts that existed | |
4411 | * before the restart are considered already present so will be | |
4412 | * found while iterating, whether they've been re-added already | |
4413 | * or not. | |
3448c005 JB |
4414 | */ |
4415 | void ieee80211_iter_chan_contexts_atomic( | |
4416 | struct ieee80211_hw *hw, | |
4417 | void (*iter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, | |
4418 | struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *chanctx_conf, | |
4419 | void *data), | |
4420 | void *iter_data); | |
4421 | ||
a619a4c0 JO |
4422 | /** |
4423 | * ieee80211_ap_probereq_get - retrieve a Probe Request template | |
4424 | * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw(). | |
4425 | * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. | |
4426 | * | |
4427 | * Creates a Probe Request template which can, for example, be uploaded to | |
4428 | * hardware. The template is filled with bssid, ssid and supported rate | |
4429 | * information. This function must only be called from within the | |
4430 | * .bss_info_changed callback function and only in managed mode. The function | |
4431 | * is only useful when the interface is associated, otherwise it will return | |
0ae997dc YB |
4432 | * %NULL. |
4433 | * | |
4434 | * Return: The Probe Request template. %NULL on error. | |
a619a4c0 JO |
4435 | */ |
4436 | struct sk_buff *ieee80211_ap_probereq_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, | |
4437 | struct ieee80211_vif *vif); | |
4438 | ||
04de8381 KV |
4439 | /** |
4440 | * ieee80211_beacon_loss - inform hardware does not receive beacons | |
4441 | * | |
1ed32e4f | 4442 | * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. |
04de8381 | 4443 | * |
c1288b12 | 4444 | * When beacon filtering is enabled with %IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER and |
1e4dcd01 | 4445 | * %IEEE80211_CONF_PS is set, the driver needs to inform whenever the |
04de8381 KV |
4446 | * hardware is not receiving beacons with this function. |
4447 | */ | |
4448 | void ieee80211_beacon_loss(struct ieee80211_vif *vif); | |
4b7679a5 | 4449 | |
1e4dcd01 JO |
4450 | /** |
4451 | * ieee80211_connection_loss - inform hardware has lost connection to the AP | |
4452 | * | |
4453 | * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. | |
4454 | * | |
c1288b12 | 4455 | * When beacon filtering is enabled with %IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER, and |
1e4dcd01 JO |
4456 | * %IEEE80211_CONF_PS and %IEEE80211_HW_CONNECTION_MONITOR are set, the driver |
4457 | * needs to inform if the connection to the AP has been lost. | |
682bd38b JB |
4458 | * The function may also be called if the connection needs to be terminated |
4459 | * for some other reason, even if %IEEE80211_HW_CONNECTION_MONITOR isn't set. | |
1e4dcd01 JO |
4460 | * |
4461 | * This function will cause immediate change to disassociated state, | |
4462 | * without connection recovery attempts. | |
4463 | */ | |
4464 | void ieee80211_connection_loss(struct ieee80211_vif *vif); | |
4465 | ||
95acac61 JB |
4466 | /** |
4467 | * ieee80211_resume_disconnect - disconnect from AP after resume | |
4468 | * | |
4469 | * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. | |
4470 | * | |
4471 | * Instructs mac80211 to disconnect from the AP after resume. | |
4472 | * Drivers can use this after WoWLAN if they know that the | |
4473 | * connection cannot be kept up, for example because keys were | |
4474 | * used while the device was asleep but the replay counters or | |
4475 | * similar cannot be retrieved from the device during resume. | |
4476 | * | |
4477 | * Note that due to implementation issues, if the driver uses | |
4478 | * the reconfiguration functionality during resume the interface | |
4479 | * will still be added as associated first during resume and then | |
4480 | * disconnect normally later. | |
4481 | * | |
4482 | * This function can only be called from the resume callback and | |
4483 | * the driver must not be holding any of its own locks while it | |
4484 | * calls this function, or at least not any locks it needs in the | |
4485 | * key configuration paths (if it supports HW crypto). | |
4486 | */ | |
4487 | void ieee80211_resume_disconnect(struct ieee80211_vif *vif); | |
f90754c1 | 4488 | |
a97c13c3 JO |
4489 | /** |
4490 | * ieee80211_cqm_rssi_notify - inform a configured connection quality monitoring | |
4491 | * rssi threshold triggered | |
4492 | * | |
4493 | * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. | |
4494 | * @rssi_event: the RSSI trigger event type | |
4495 | * @gfp: context flags | |
4496 | * | |
ea086359 | 4497 | * When the %IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_CQM_RSSI is set, and a connection quality |
a97c13c3 JO |
4498 | * monitoring is configured with an rssi threshold, the driver will inform |
4499 | * whenever the rssi level reaches the threshold. | |
4500 | */ | |
4501 | void ieee80211_cqm_rssi_notify(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, | |
4502 | enum nl80211_cqm_rssi_threshold_event rssi_event, | |
4503 | gfp_t gfp); | |
4504 | ||
164eb02d SW |
4505 | /** |
4506 | * ieee80211_radar_detected - inform that a radar was detected | |
4507 | * | |
4508 | * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw() | |
4509 | */ | |
4510 | void ieee80211_radar_detected(struct ieee80211_hw *hw); | |
4511 | ||
5ce6e438 JB |
4512 | /** |
4513 | * ieee80211_chswitch_done - Complete channel switch process | |
4514 | * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. | |
4515 | * @success: make the channel switch successful or not | |
4516 | * | |
4517 | * Complete the channel switch post-process: set the new operational channel | |
4518 | * and wake up the suspended queues. | |
4519 | */ | |
4520 | void ieee80211_chswitch_done(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, bool success); | |
4521 | ||
d1f5b7a3 JB |
4522 | /** |
4523 | * ieee80211_request_smps - request SM PS transition | |
4524 | * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. | |
633dd1ea | 4525 | * @smps_mode: new SM PS mode |
d1f5b7a3 JB |
4526 | * |
4527 | * This allows the driver to request an SM PS transition in managed | |
4528 | * mode. This is useful when the driver has more information than | |
4529 | * the stack about possible interference, for example by bluetooth. | |
4530 | */ | |
4531 | void ieee80211_request_smps(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, | |
4532 | enum ieee80211_smps_mode smps_mode); | |
4533 | ||
21f83589 JB |
4534 | /** |
4535 | * ieee80211_ready_on_channel - notification of remain-on-channel start | |
4536 | * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw() | |
4537 | */ | |
4538 | void ieee80211_ready_on_channel(struct ieee80211_hw *hw); | |
4539 | ||
4540 | /** | |
4541 | * ieee80211_remain_on_channel_expired - remain_on_channel duration expired | |
4542 | * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw() | |
4543 | */ | |
4544 | void ieee80211_remain_on_channel_expired(struct ieee80211_hw *hw); | |
4545 | ||
f41ccd71 SL |
4546 | /** |
4547 | * ieee80211_stop_rx_ba_session - callback to stop existing BA sessions | |
4548 | * | |
4549 | * in order not to harm the system performance and user experience, the device | |
4550 | * may request not to allow any rx ba session and tear down existing rx ba | |
4551 | * sessions based on system constraints such as periodic BT activity that needs | |
4552 | * to limit wlan activity (eg.sco or a2dp)." | |
4553 | * in such cases, the intention is to limit the duration of the rx ppdu and | |
4554 | * therefore prevent the peer device to use a-mpdu aggregation. | |
4555 | * | |
4556 | * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. | |
4557 | * @ba_rx_bitmap: Bit map of open rx ba per tid | |
4558 | * @addr: & to bssid mac address | |
4559 | */ | |
4560 | void ieee80211_stop_rx_ba_session(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, u16 ba_rx_bitmap, | |
4561 | const u8 *addr); | |
4562 | ||
8c771244 FF |
4563 | /** |
4564 | * ieee80211_send_bar - send a BlockAckReq frame | |
4565 | * | |
4566 | * can be used to flush pending frames from the peer's aggregation reorder | |
4567 | * buffer. | |
4568 | * | |
4569 | * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. | |
4570 | * @ra: the peer's destination address | |
4571 | * @tid: the TID of the aggregation session | |
4572 | * @ssn: the new starting sequence number for the receiver | |
4573 | */ | |
4574 | void ieee80211_send_bar(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, u8 *ra, u16 tid, u16 ssn); | |
4575 | ||
4b7679a5 | 4576 | /* Rate control API */ |
e6a9854b | 4577 | |
4b7679a5 | 4578 | /** |
e6a9854b JB |
4579 | * struct ieee80211_tx_rate_control - rate control information for/from RC algo |
4580 | * | |
4581 | * @hw: The hardware the algorithm is invoked for. | |
4582 | * @sband: The band this frame is being transmitted on. | |
4583 | * @bss_conf: the current BSS configuration | |
f44d4eb5 SW |
4584 | * @skb: the skb that will be transmitted, the control information in it needs |
4585 | * to be filled in | |
e6a9854b JB |
4586 | * @reported_rate: The rate control algorithm can fill this in to indicate |
4587 | * which rate should be reported to userspace as the current rate and | |
4588 | * used for rate calculations in the mesh network. | |
4589 | * @rts: whether RTS will be used for this frame because it is longer than the | |
4590 | * RTS threshold | |
4591 | * @short_preamble: whether mac80211 will request short-preamble transmission | |
4592 | * if the selected rate supports it | |
f44d4eb5 | 4593 | * @max_rate_idx: user-requested maximum (legacy) rate |
37eb0b16 JM |
4594 | * (deprecated; this will be removed once drivers get updated to use |
4595 | * rate_idx_mask) | |
f44d4eb5 | 4596 | * @rate_idx_mask: user-requested (legacy) rate mask |
2ffbe6d3 | 4597 | * @rate_idx_mcs_mask: user-requested MCS rate mask (NULL if not in use) |
8f0729b1 | 4598 | * @bss: whether this frame is sent out in AP or IBSS mode |
e6a9854b JB |
4599 | */ |
4600 | struct ieee80211_tx_rate_control { | |
4601 | struct ieee80211_hw *hw; | |
4602 | struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband; | |
4603 | struct ieee80211_bss_conf *bss_conf; | |
4604 | struct sk_buff *skb; | |
4605 | struct ieee80211_tx_rate reported_rate; | |
4606 | bool rts, short_preamble; | |
4607 | u8 max_rate_idx; | |
37eb0b16 | 4608 | u32 rate_idx_mask; |
2ffbe6d3 | 4609 | u8 *rate_idx_mcs_mask; |
8f0729b1 | 4610 | bool bss; |
4b7679a5 JB |
4611 | }; |
4612 | ||
4613 | struct rate_control_ops { | |
4b7679a5 JB |
4614 | const char *name; |
4615 | void *(*alloc)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct dentry *debugfsdir); | |
4b7679a5 JB |
4616 | void (*free)(void *priv); |
4617 | ||
4618 | void *(*alloc_sta)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_sta *sta, gfp_t gfp); | |
4619 | void (*rate_init)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband, | |
3de805cf | 4620 | struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef, |
4b7679a5 | 4621 | struct ieee80211_sta *sta, void *priv_sta); |
81cb7623 | 4622 | void (*rate_update)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband, |
3de805cf | 4623 | struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef, |
64f68e5d JB |
4624 | struct ieee80211_sta *sta, void *priv_sta, |
4625 | u32 changed); | |
4b7679a5 JB |
4626 | void (*free_sta)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_sta *sta, |
4627 | void *priv_sta); | |
4628 | ||
4629 | void (*tx_status)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband, | |
4630 | struct ieee80211_sta *sta, void *priv_sta, | |
4631 | struct sk_buff *skb); | |
e6a9854b JB |
4632 | void (*get_rate)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_sta *sta, void *priv_sta, |
4633 | struct ieee80211_tx_rate_control *txrc); | |
4b7679a5 JB |
4634 | |
4635 | void (*add_sta_debugfs)(void *priv, void *priv_sta, | |
4636 | struct dentry *dir); | |
4637 | void (*remove_sta_debugfs)(void *priv, void *priv_sta); | |
cca674d4 AQ |
4638 | |
4639 | u32 (*get_expected_throughput)(void *priv_sta); | |
4b7679a5 JB |
4640 | }; |
4641 | ||
4642 | static inline int rate_supported(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, | |
4643 | enum ieee80211_band band, | |
4644 | int index) | |
4645 | { | |
4646 | return (sta == NULL || sta->supp_rates[band] & BIT(index)); | |
4647 | } | |
4648 | ||
4c6d4f5c LR |
4649 | /** |
4650 | * rate_control_send_low - helper for drivers for management/no-ack frames | |
4651 | * | |
4652 | * Rate control algorithms that agree to use the lowest rate to | |
4653 | * send management frames and NO_ACK data with the respective hw | |
4654 | * retries should use this in the beginning of their mac80211 get_rate | |
4655 | * callback. If true is returned the rate control can simply return. | |
4656 | * If false is returned we guarantee that sta and sta and priv_sta is | |
4657 | * not null. | |
4658 | * | |
4659 | * Rate control algorithms wishing to do more intelligent selection of | |
4660 | * rate for multicast/broadcast frames may choose to not use this. | |
4661 | * | |
4662 | * @sta: &struct ieee80211_sta pointer to the target destination. Note | |
4663 | * that this may be null. | |
4664 | * @priv_sta: private rate control structure. This may be null. | |
4665 | * @txrc: rate control information we sholud populate for mac80211. | |
4666 | */ | |
4667 | bool rate_control_send_low(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, | |
4668 | void *priv_sta, | |
4669 | struct ieee80211_tx_rate_control *txrc); | |
4670 | ||
4671 | ||
4b7679a5 JB |
4672 | static inline s8 |
4673 | rate_lowest_index(struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband, | |
4674 | struct ieee80211_sta *sta) | |
4675 | { | |
4676 | int i; | |
4677 | ||
4678 | for (i = 0; i < sband->n_bitrates; i++) | |
4679 | if (rate_supported(sta, sband->band, i)) | |
4680 | return i; | |
4681 | ||
4682 | /* warn when we cannot find a rate. */ | |
54d5026e | 4683 | WARN_ON_ONCE(1); |
4b7679a5 | 4684 | |
54d5026e | 4685 | /* and return 0 (the lowest index) */ |
4b7679a5 JB |
4686 | return 0; |
4687 | } | |
4688 | ||
b770b43e LR |
4689 | static inline |
4690 | bool rate_usable_index_exists(struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband, | |
4691 | struct ieee80211_sta *sta) | |
4692 | { | |
4693 | unsigned int i; | |
4694 | ||
4695 | for (i = 0; i < sband->n_bitrates; i++) | |
4696 | if (rate_supported(sta, sband->band, i)) | |
4697 | return true; | |
4698 | return false; | |
4699 | } | |
4b7679a5 | 4700 | |
0d528d85 FF |
4701 | /** |
4702 | * rate_control_set_rates - pass the sta rate selection to mac80211/driver | |
4703 | * | |
4704 | * When not doing a rate control probe to test rates, rate control should pass | |
4705 | * its rate selection to mac80211. If the driver supports receiving a station | |
4706 | * rate table, it will use it to ensure that frames are always sent based on | |
4707 | * the most recent rate control module decision. | |
4708 | * | |
4709 | * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw() | |
4710 | * @pubsta: &struct ieee80211_sta pointer to the target destination. | |
4711 | * @rates: new tx rate set to be used for this station. | |
4712 | */ | |
4713 | int rate_control_set_rates(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, | |
4714 | struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta, | |
4715 | struct ieee80211_sta_rates *rates); | |
4716 | ||
631ad703 JB |
4717 | int ieee80211_rate_control_register(const struct rate_control_ops *ops); |
4718 | void ieee80211_rate_control_unregister(const struct rate_control_ops *ops); | |
4b7679a5 | 4719 | |
10c806b3 LR |
4720 | static inline bool |
4721 | conf_is_ht20(struct ieee80211_conf *conf) | |
4722 | { | |
675a0b04 | 4723 | return conf->chandef.width == NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20; |
10c806b3 LR |
4724 | } |
4725 | ||
4726 | static inline bool | |
4727 | conf_is_ht40_minus(struct ieee80211_conf *conf) | |
4728 | { | |
675a0b04 KB |
4729 | return conf->chandef.width == NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40 && |
4730 | conf->chandef.center_freq1 < conf->chandef.chan->center_freq; | |
10c806b3 LR |
4731 | } |
4732 | ||
4733 | static inline bool | |
4734 | conf_is_ht40_plus(struct ieee80211_conf *conf) | |
4735 | { | |
675a0b04 KB |
4736 | return conf->chandef.width == NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40 && |
4737 | conf->chandef.center_freq1 > conf->chandef.chan->center_freq; | |
10c806b3 LR |
4738 | } |
4739 | ||
4740 | static inline bool | |
4741 | conf_is_ht40(struct ieee80211_conf *conf) | |
4742 | { | |
675a0b04 | 4743 | return conf->chandef.width == NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40; |
10c806b3 LR |
4744 | } |
4745 | ||
4746 | static inline bool | |
4747 | conf_is_ht(struct ieee80211_conf *conf) | |
4748 | { | |
041f607d RL |
4749 | return (conf->chandef.width != NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_5) && |
4750 | (conf->chandef.width != NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_10) && | |
4751 | (conf->chandef.width != NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20_NOHT); | |
10c806b3 LR |
4752 | } |
4753 | ||
2ca27bcf JB |
4754 | static inline enum nl80211_iftype |
4755 | ieee80211_iftype_p2p(enum nl80211_iftype type, bool p2p) | |
4756 | { | |
4757 | if (p2p) { | |
4758 | switch (type) { | |
4759 | case NL80211_IFTYPE_STATION: | |
4760 | return NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_CLIENT; | |
4761 | case NL80211_IFTYPE_AP: | |
4762 | return NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_GO; | |
4763 | default: | |
4764 | break; | |
4765 | } | |
4766 | } | |
4767 | return type; | |
4768 | } | |
4769 | ||
4770 | static inline enum nl80211_iftype | |
4771 | ieee80211_vif_type_p2p(struct ieee80211_vif *vif) | |
4772 | { | |
4773 | return ieee80211_iftype_p2p(vif->type, vif->p2p); | |
4774 | } | |
4775 | ||
615f7b9b MV |
4776 | void ieee80211_enable_rssi_reports(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, |
4777 | int rssi_min_thold, | |
4778 | int rssi_max_thold); | |
4779 | ||
4780 | void ieee80211_disable_rssi_reports(struct ieee80211_vif *vif); | |
768db343 | 4781 | |
0d8a0a17 | 4782 | /** |
0ae997dc | 4783 | * ieee80211_ave_rssi - report the average RSSI for the specified interface |
0d8a0a17 WYG |
4784 | * |
4785 | * @vif: the specified virtual interface | |
4786 | * | |
0ae997dc YB |
4787 | * Note: This function assumes that the given vif is valid. |
4788 | * | |
4789 | * Return: The average RSSI value for the requested interface, or 0 if not | |
4790 | * applicable. | |
0d8a0a17 | 4791 | */ |
1dae27f8 WYG |
4792 | int ieee80211_ave_rssi(struct ieee80211_vif *vif); |
4793 | ||
cd8f7cb4 JB |
4794 | /** |
4795 | * ieee80211_report_wowlan_wakeup - report WoWLAN wakeup | |
4796 | * @vif: virtual interface | |
4797 | * @wakeup: wakeup reason(s) | |
4798 | * @gfp: allocation flags | |
4799 | * | |
4800 | * See cfg80211_report_wowlan_wakeup(). | |
4801 | */ | |
4802 | void ieee80211_report_wowlan_wakeup(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, | |
4803 | struct cfg80211_wowlan_wakeup *wakeup, | |
4804 | gfp_t gfp); | |
4805 | ||
06be6b14 FF |
4806 | /** |
4807 | * ieee80211_tx_prepare_skb - prepare an 802.11 skb for transmission | |
4808 | * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw() | |
4809 | * @vif: virtual interface | |
4810 | * @skb: frame to be sent from within the driver | |
4811 | * @band: the band to transmit on | |
4812 | * @sta: optional pointer to get the station to send the frame to | |
4813 | * | |
4814 | * Note: must be called under RCU lock | |
4815 | */ | |
4816 | bool ieee80211_tx_prepare_skb(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, | |
4817 | struct ieee80211_vif *vif, struct sk_buff *skb, | |
4818 | int band, struct ieee80211_sta **sta); | |
4819 | ||
a7022e65 FF |
4820 | /** |
4821 | * struct ieee80211_noa_data - holds temporary data for tracking P2P NoA state | |
4822 | * | |
4823 | * @next_tsf: TSF timestamp of the next absent state change | |
4824 | * @has_next_tsf: next absent state change event pending | |
4825 | * | |
4826 | * @absent: descriptor bitmask, set if GO is currently absent | |
4827 | * | |
4828 | * private: | |
4829 | * | |
4830 | * @count: count fields from the NoA descriptors | |
4831 | * @desc: adjusted data from the NoA | |
4832 | */ | |
4833 | struct ieee80211_noa_data { | |
4834 | u32 next_tsf; | |
4835 | bool has_next_tsf; | |
4836 | ||
4837 | u8 absent; | |
4838 | ||
4839 | u8 count[IEEE80211_P2P_NOA_DESC_MAX]; | |
4840 | struct { | |
4841 | u32 start; | |
4842 | u32 duration; | |
4843 | u32 interval; | |
4844 | } desc[IEEE80211_P2P_NOA_DESC_MAX]; | |
4845 | }; | |
4846 | ||
4847 | /** | |
4848 | * ieee80211_parse_p2p_noa - initialize NoA tracking data from P2P IE | |
4849 | * | |
4850 | * @attr: P2P NoA IE | |
4851 | * @data: NoA tracking data | |
4852 | * @tsf: current TSF timestamp | |
4853 | * | |
4854 | * Return: number of successfully parsed descriptors | |
4855 | */ | |
4856 | int ieee80211_parse_p2p_noa(const struct ieee80211_p2p_noa_attr *attr, | |
4857 | struct ieee80211_noa_data *data, u32 tsf); | |
4858 | ||
4859 | /** | |
4860 | * ieee80211_update_p2p_noa - get next pending P2P GO absent state change | |
4861 | * | |
4862 | * @data: NoA tracking data | |
4863 | * @tsf: current TSF timestamp | |
4864 | */ | |
4865 | void ieee80211_update_p2p_noa(struct ieee80211_noa_data *data, u32 tsf); | |
4866 | ||
c887f0d3 AN |
4867 | /** |
4868 | * ieee80211_tdls_oper - request userspace to perform a TDLS operation | |
4869 | * @vif: virtual interface | |
4870 | * @peer: the peer's destination address | |
4871 | * @oper: the requested TDLS operation | |
4872 | * @reason_code: reason code for the operation, valid for TDLS teardown | |
4873 | * @gfp: allocation flags | |
4874 | * | |
4875 | * See cfg80211_tdls_oper_request(). | |
4876 | */ | |
4877 | void ieee80211_tdls_oper_request(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *peer, | |
4878 | enum nl80211_tdls_operation oper, | |
4879 | u16 reason_code, gfp_t gfp); | |
f0706e82 | 4880 | #endif /* MAC80211_H */ |